1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger.
3 Copyright (C) 1992-1994, 1997-2000, 2003-2005, 2007-2012 Free
4 Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GDB.
8 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
13 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
24 #include "gdb_string.h"
28 #include "gdb_regex.h"
33 #include "expression.h"
34 #include "parser-defs.h"
40 #include "breakpoint.h"
43 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
45 #include "completer.h"
52 #include "dictionary.h"
53 #include "exceptions.h"
64 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
65 #include "arch-utils.h"
66 #include "exceptions.h"
67 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
69 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
70 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
71 Copied from valarith.c. */
73 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
74 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
77 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
79 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
81 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
83 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
85 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
87 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
89 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
91 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
93 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
95 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
97 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
99 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
101 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
103 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
105 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
107 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
109 static int full_match (const char *, const char *);
111 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *);
113 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
114 struct block *, const char *,
115 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int);
117 static int is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info *, int);
119 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
122 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
124 static struct ada_symbol_info *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
126 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int,
129 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int,
130 struct symbol *, struct block *);
132 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
134 static char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
136 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
138 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
140 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
142 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
144 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
146 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *,
151 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *,
154 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, char *,
157 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
159 static struct type *ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *,
162 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
164 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
166 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
168 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
170 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (struct type *, struct value *);
172 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
173 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
175 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
177 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
179 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
181 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
183 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
185 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
187 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
189 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
192 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int, int);
194 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
197 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *);
199 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
201 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
203 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
205 static int advance_wild_match (const char **, const char *, int);
207 static int wild_match (const char *, const char *);
209 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
211 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
213 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
215 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
217 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
220 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (char *, struct value *, int,
223 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int,
226 static int find_struct_field (const char *, struct type *, int,
227 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
229 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR,
232 static int ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info *, int,
233 struct value **, int, const char *,
236 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
238 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
239 struct language_arch_info *);
241 static void check_size (const struct type *);
243 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
246 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
250 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
252 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
253 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
255 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
257 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
261 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
263 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
266 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
269 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
272 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
275 static struct type *ada_find_any_type (const char *name);
279 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
280 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
282 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-09-17: No longer a const because it is
283 returned by a function that does not return a const char *. */
284 static char *ada_completer_word_break_characters =
286 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
288 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
291 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
292 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
293 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
295 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
296 static int warning_limit = 2;
298 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
299 expression evaluation. */
300 static int warnings_issued = 0;
302 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
303 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
306 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
307 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
310 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */
311 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack;
313 /* Inferior-specific data. */
315 /* Per-inferior data for this module. */
317 struct ada_inferior_data
319 /* The ada__tags__type_specific_data type, which is used when decoding
320 tagged types. With older versions of GNAT, this type was directly
321 accessible through a component ("tsd") in the object tag. But this
322 is no longer the case, so we cache it for each inferior. */
323 struct type *tsd_type;
325 /* The exception_support_info data. This data is used to determine
326 how to implement support for Ada exception catchpoints in a given
328 const struct exception_support_info *exception_info;
331 /* Our key to this module's inferior data. */
332 static const struct inferior_data *ada_inferior_data;
334 /* A cleanup routine for our inferior data. */
336 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (struct inferior *inf, void *arg)
338 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
340 data = inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data);
345 /* Return our inferior data for the given inferior (INF).
347 This function always returns a valid pointer to an allocated
348 ada_inferior_data structure. If INF's inferior data has not
349 been previously set, this functions creates a new one with all
350 fields set to zero, sets INF's inferior to it, and then returns
351 a pointer to that newly allocated ada_inferior_data. */
353 static struct ada_inferior_data *
354 get_ada_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
356 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
358 data = inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data);
361 data = XZALLOC (struct ada_inferior_data);
362 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, data);
368 /* Perform all necessary cleanups regarding our module's inferior data
369 that is required after the inferior INF just exited. */
372 ada_inferior_exit (struct inferior *inf)
374 ada_inferior_data_cleanup (inf, NULL);
375 set_inferior_data (inf, ada_inferior_data, NULL);
380 /* If TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF type, return the target type after
381 all typedef layers have been peeled. Otherwise, return TYPE.
383 Normally, we really expect a typedef type to only have 1 typedef layer.
384 In other words, we really expect the target type of a typedef type to be
385 a non-typedef type. This is particularly true for Ada units, because
386 the language does not have a typedef vs not-typedef distinction.
387 In that respect, the Ada compiler has been trying to eliminate as many
388 typedef definitions in the debugging information, since they generally
389 do not bring any extra information (we still use typedef under certain
390 circumstances related mostly to the GNAT encoding).
392 Unfortunately, we have seen situations where the debugging information
393 generated by the compiler leads to such multiple typedef layers. For
394 instance, consider the following example with stabs:
396 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:Tt(0,46)=s16P_ARRAY:(0,47)=[...]"[...]
397 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:t(0,36)=(0,46)",128,0,6,0
399 This is an error in the debugging information which causes type
400 pck__float_array___XUP to be defined twice, and the second time,
401 it is defined as a typedef of a typedef.
403 This is on the fringe of legality as far as debugging information is
404 concerned, and certainly unexpected. But it is easy to handle these
405 situations correctly, so we can afford to be lenient in this case. */
408 ada_typedef_target_type (struct type *type)
410 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
411 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
415 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
416 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
417 its unqualified name. */
420 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
422 const char *result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
425 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
427 result = decoded_name;
432 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'.
433 The result is good until the next call. */
436 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
438 static char *result = NULL;
441 result = xstrprintf ("<%s>", str);
446 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
448 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
451 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
454 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
455 const struct value_print_options *options)
457 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
458 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
461 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
462 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
463 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
466 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
468 if (*size < min_size)
471 if (*size < min_size)
473 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
478 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
479 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
482 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
484 int len = strlen (target);
487 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
488 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
489 || (strncmp (field_name + len, "___", 3) == 0
490 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
495 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
496 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
497 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
498 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
499 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
500 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
501 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
504 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
508 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
510 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
511 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
515 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
516 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type));
521 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
524 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
530 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
533 return strlen (name);
539 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
540 Return zero if STR is null. */
543 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
550 len2 = strlen (suffix);
551 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
554 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
555 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
557 static struct value *
558 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
560 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
561 if (value_type (val) == type)
565 struct value *result;
567 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
568 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
572 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
573 result = allocate_value_lazy (type);
576 result = allocate_value (type);
577 memcpy (value_contents_raw (result), value_contents (val),
580 set_value_component_location (result, val);
581 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
582 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
583 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
584 set_value_optimized_out (result, value_optimized_out (val));
589 static const gdb_byte *
590 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
595 return valaddr + offset;
599 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
604 return address + offset;
607 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
608 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
609 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
612 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
613 provided by "complaint". */
614 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF (1, 2);
617 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
621 va_start (args, format);
622 warnings_issued += 1;
623 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
624 vwarning (format, args);
629 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
630 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
634 check_size (const struct type *type)
636 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
637 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
640 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
642 max_of_size (int size)
644 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
646 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
649 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
651 min_of_size (int size)
653 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
656 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
658 umax_of_size (int size)
660 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
662 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
665 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
667 max_of_type (struct type *t)
669 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
670 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
672 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
675 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
677 min_of_type (struct type *t)
679 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
682 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
685 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
687 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
689 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
691 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
692 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
694 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
699 return max_of_type (type);
701 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound."));
705 /* The smallest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
707 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
709 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
711 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
712 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
714 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, 0);
719 return min_of_type (type);
721 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound."));
725 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
726 non-range scalar type. */
729 get_base_type (struct type *type)
731 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
733 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
735 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
740 /* Return a decoded version of the given VALUE. This means returning
741 a value whose type is obtained by applying all the GNAT-specific
742 encondings, making the resulting type a static but standard description
743 of the initial type. */
746 ada_get_decoded_value (struct value *value)
748 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (value));
750 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)
751 || (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)
752 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR))
754 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) /* array access type. */
755 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (value);
757 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (value);
760 value = ada_to_fixed_value (value);
765 /* Same as ada_get_decoded_value, but with the given TYPE.
766 Because there is no associated actual value for this type,
767 the resulting type might be a best-effort approximation in
768 the case of dynamic types. */
771 ada_get_decoded_type (struct type *type)
773 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
774 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
775 type = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (type);
781 /* Language Selection */
783 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
784 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found). */
787 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang)
789 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL,
790 (struct objfile *) NULL) != NULL)
796 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
797 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
798 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
803 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
804 static char *main_program_name = NULL;
806 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
807 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
808 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
809 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
811 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
815 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
818 main_program_name_addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
819 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
820 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
822 xfree (main_program_name);
823 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
828 return main_program_name;
831 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
837 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
840 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
841 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
842 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
843 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
844 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
845 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
846 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
847 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
848 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
849 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
850 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
851 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
852 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
853 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
854 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
855 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
856 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
857 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
858 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
859 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
860 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
861 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
865 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
866 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
869 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
871 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
872 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
879 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
880 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
883 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
887 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
892 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
894 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
895 mapping->encoded != NULL
896 && strncmp (mapping->decoded, p,
897 strlen (mapping->decoded)) != 0; mapping += 1)
899 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
900 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
901 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
902 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
907 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
912 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
913 return encoding_buffer;
916 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
917 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
921 ada_fold_name (const char *name)
923 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
924 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
926 int len = strlen (name);
927 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
931 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2);
932 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
938 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
939 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
945 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
948 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
950 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
953 /* ENCODED is the linkage name of a symbol and LEN contains its length.
954 This function saves in LEN the length of that same symbol name but
955 without either of these suffixes:
961 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
962 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
963 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
966 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
968 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
972 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
974 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
976 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
978 else if (i >= 2 && strncmp (encoded + i - 2, "___", 3) == 0)
980 else if (i >= 1 && strncmp (encoded + i - 1, "__", 2) == 0)
985 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
989 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
991 /* Remove trailing N. */
993 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
994 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
995 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
996 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
997 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
998 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
999 entity is internal. */
1002 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
1003 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
1007 /* Remove trailing X[bn]* suffixes (indicating names in package bodies). */
1010 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
1014 while (i > 0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'))
1017 if (encoded[i] != 'X')
1023 if (isalnum (encoded[i-1]))
1027 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
1028 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
1029 replaced by ENCODED.
1031 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode.
1032 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer
1036 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
1043 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL;
1044 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0;
1046 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
1047 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
1048 if we see this prefix. */
1049 if (strncmp (encoded, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
1052 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
1053 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
1054 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
1055 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
1058 len0 = strlen (encoded);
1060 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
1061 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
1063 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
1064 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
1065 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
1066 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
1067 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
1068 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
1076 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
1077 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
1078 appear in the decoded name. */
1080 if (len0 > 3 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB", 3) == 0)
1083 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
1084 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
1087 if (len0 > 2 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB", 2) == 0)
1090 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
1091 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
1093 if (len0 > 1 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 1, "B", 1) == 0)
1096 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
1098 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1);
1099 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1101 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
1103 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
1106 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1107 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
1109 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
1111 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
1115 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
1116 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
1118 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
1119 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1124 /* Is this a symbol function? */
1125 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
1129 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1131 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1132 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1134 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1136 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1139 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1143 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1148 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1149 into "." (just below). */
1151 if (i < len0 - 4 && strncmp (encoded + i, "TK__", 4) == 0)
1154 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1155 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1156 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1158 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1159 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1160 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1164 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1165 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1167 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1168 is indeed followed by "__". */
1169 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1173 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1175 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1176 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1177 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1178 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1179 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1182 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1183 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1184 internally generated. */
1186 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1187 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1191 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1195 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1198 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1199 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1200 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1202 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1207 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1208 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1211 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1213 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1214 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1215 digits or lowercase characters. */
1216 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1218 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1221 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1225 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1227 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1228 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1229 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1230 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1231 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1232 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1236 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1240 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1242 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1250 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1252 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1257 decoded[j] = '\000';
1259 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1260 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1262 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1)
1263 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1266 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0)
1272 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3);
1273 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1274 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1275 strcpy (decoded, encoded);
1277 xsnprintf (decoded, decoding_buffer_size, "<%s>", encoded);
1282 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1283 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1284 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1285 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1286 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1287 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1289 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1290 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1291 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1292 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1293 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1295 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1296 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1297 when a decoded name is cached in it. */
1300 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol)
1303 (char **) &gsymbol->language_specific.mangled_lang.demangled_name;
1305 if (*resultp == NULL)
1307 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name);
1309 if (gsymbol->obj_section != NULL)
1311 struct objfile *objf = gsymbol->obj_section->objfile;
1313 *resultp = obsavestring (decoded, strlen (decoded),
1314 &objf->objfile_obstack);
1316 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in which
1317 case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only decode
1318 when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1319 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1320 if (*resultp == NULL)
1322 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1326 *slot = xstrdup (decoded);
1335 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1337 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded));
1340 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing
1341 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on
1342 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
1343 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a
1344 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if
1345 either argument is NULL. */
1348 match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild)
1350 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL)
1353 return wild_match (sym_name, name) == 0;
1356 int len_name = strlen (name);
1358 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0
1359 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name))
1360 || (strncmp (sym_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0
1361 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0
1362 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5));
1369 /* Assuming that INDEX_DESC_TYPE is an ___XA structure, a structure
1370 generated by the GNAT compiler to describe the index type used
1371 for each dimension of an array, check whether it follows the latest
1372 known encoding. If not, fix it up to conform to the latest encoding.
1373 Otherwise, do nothing. This function also does nothing if
1374 INDEX_DESC_TYPE is NULL.
1376 The GNAT encoding used to describle the array index type evolved a bit.
1377 Initially, the information would be provided through the name of each
1378 field of the structure type only, while the type of these fields was
1379 described as unspecified and irrelevant. The debugger was then expected
1380 to perform a global type lookup using the name of that field in order
1381 to get access to the full index type description. Because these global
1382 lookups can be very expensive, the encoding was later enhanced to make
1383 the global lookup unnecessary by defining the field type as being
1384 the full index type description.
1386 The purpose of this routine is to allow us to support older versions
1387 of the compiler by detecting the use of the older encoding, and by
1388 fixing up the INDEX_DESC_TYPE to follow the new one (at this point,
1389 we essentially replace each field's meaningless type by the associated
1393 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (struct type *index_desc_type)
1397 if (index_desc_type == NULL)
1399 gdb_assert (TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type) > 0);
1401 /* Check if INDEX_DESC_TYPE follows the older encoding (it is sufficient
1402 to check one field only, no need to check them all). If not, return
1405 If our INDEX_DESC_TYPE was generated using the older encoding,
1406 the field type should be a meaningless integer type whose name
1407 is not equal to the field name. */
1408 if (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)) != NULL
1409 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)),
1410 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, 0)) == 0)
1413 /* Fixup each field of INDEX_DESC_TYPE. */
1414 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type); i++)
1416 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, i);
1417 struct type *raw_type = ada_check_typedef (ada_find_any_type (name));
1420 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, i) = raw_type;
1424 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1426 static char *bound_name[] = {
1427 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1428 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1431 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1433 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1436 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1439 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1440 level of indirection, if needed. */
1442 static struct type *
1443 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1447 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1448 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
1449 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
1452 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1453 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1454 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1459 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1462 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1465 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1466 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1469 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1471 static struct type *
1472 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1474 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1476 if (base_type == NULL)
1478 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1482 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1484 if (alt_type == NULL)
1491 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1493 static struct value *
1494 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1496 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
1497 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1499 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1501 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1502 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1504 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1507 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1510 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1512 type = desc_base_type (type);
1513 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1514 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1517 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1518 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1520 static struct type *
1521 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1525 type = desc_base_type (type);
1529 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1531 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1534 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1536 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1538 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1540 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1542 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1547 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1548 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1550 static struct value *
1551 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1553 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1555 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1557 struct type *bounds_type =
1558 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1561 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1562 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1564 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1565 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1566 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1567 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1568 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1570 addr = value_address (arr);
1573 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1574 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1577 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1579 struct value *p_bounds = value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1580 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1581 struct type *p_bounds_type = value_type (p_bounds);
1584 && TYPE_CODE (p_bounds_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1586 struct type *target_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_bounds_type);
1588 if (TYPE_STUB (target_type))
1589 p_bounds = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type
1590 (ada_check_typedef (target_type)),
1594 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1602 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1603 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1606 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1608 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1611 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1612 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1615 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1617 type = desc_base_type (type);
1619 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1620 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1622 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1625 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1626 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1627 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1630 static struct type *
1631 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1633 type = desc_base_type (type);
1635 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1636 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1637 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1638 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1640 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1643 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1644 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type));
1650 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1653 static struct value *
1654 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1656 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1658 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1659 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1660 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1661 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1662 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1668 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1669 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1672 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1674 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1677 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1678 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1681 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1683 type = desc_base_type (type);
1685 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1686 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1688 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1691 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1692 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1693 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1695 static struct value *
1696 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1698 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1699 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1702 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1703 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1704 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1707 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1709 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1712 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1713 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1714 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1717 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1719 type = desc_base_type (type);
1721 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1722 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1724 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1727 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1728 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1730 static struct type *
1731 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1733 type = desc_base_type (type);
1735 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1736 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1741 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1742 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1745 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1747 type = desc_base_type (type);
1750 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1754 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1755 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1759 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1763 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1764 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1765 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1768 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1772 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1775 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1776 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1777 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1778 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1781 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1784 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1788 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1789 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1790 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1791 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
1792 == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1795 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1798 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1800 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1804 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1805 return (data_type != NULL
1806 && TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1807 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1810 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1811 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1812 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1816 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1820 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1821 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1822 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1823 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1827 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1828 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1829 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1830 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1831 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1832 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1835 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1837 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1838 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1840 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1841 return value_type (arr);
1845 struct type *array_type =
1846 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1848 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1849 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1850 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1856 struct type *elt_type;
1858 struct value *descriptor;
1860 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1861 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1863 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1864 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1866 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1867 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1871 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1872 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1873 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1874 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1877 create_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1878 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1879 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1880 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1882 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1884 /* We need to store the element packed bitsize, as well as
1885 recompute the array size, because it was previously
1886 computed based on the unpacked element size. */
1887 LONGEST lo = value_as_long (low);
1888 LONGEST hi = value_as_long (high);
1890 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
1891 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1892 /* If the array has no element, then the size is already
1893 zero, and does not need to be recomputed. */
1897 (hi - lo + 1) * TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1899 TYPE_LENGTH (array_type) = (array_bitsize + 7) / 8;
1904 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1908 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1909 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1910 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1911 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1914 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1916 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1918 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1920 if (arrType == NULL)
1922 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1924 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1925 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1930 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1931 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1932 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1935 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1937 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1939 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
1942 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
1943 check_size (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
1944 return value_ind (arrVal);
1946 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1947 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1952 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
1953 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
1954 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
1957 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1959 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
1960 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
1962 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
1963 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
1968 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
1971 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1975 type = desc_base_type (type);
1976 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1978 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
1979 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
1982 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
1983 packed-array type. */
1986 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1988 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
1989 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1992 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
1993 unconstrained packed-array type. */
1996 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1998 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
1999 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2002 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
2003 return the size of its elements in bits. */
2006 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
2008 const char *raw_name;
2012 /* Access to arrays implemented as fat pointers are encoded as a typedef
2013 of the fat pointer type. We need the name of the fat pointer type
2014 to do the decoding, so strip the typedef layer. */
2015 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2016 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
2018 raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2020 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2025 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2026 gdb_assert (tail != NULL);
2028 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
2031 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
2038 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
2039 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
2040 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
2041 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
2042 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
2043 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
2044 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
2047 static struct type *
2048 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
2050 struct type *new_elt_type;
2051 struct type *new_type;
2052 struct type *index_type_desc;
2053 struct type *index_type;
2054 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
2056 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2057 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2060 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2061 if (index_type_desc)
2062 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, 0),
2065 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type);
2067 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
2069 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2071 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, index_type);
2072 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
2073 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
2075 if (get_discrete_bounds (index_type, &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
2076 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
2077 if (high_bound < low_bound)
2078 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
2081 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
2082 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
2083 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2086 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
2090 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
2091 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
2093 static struct type *
2094 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2096 const char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2099 struct type *shadow_type;
2103 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2108 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
2109 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2110 type = desc_base_type (type);
2112 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
2113 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
2115 shadow_type = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
2117 if (shadow_type == NULL)
2119 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
2122 CHECK_TYPEDEF (shadow_type);
2124 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2126 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds "
2127 "information on packed array"));
2131 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
2132 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
2135 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
2136 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
2137 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
2138 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
2139 type length is set appropriately. */
2141 static struct value *
2142 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
2146 arr = ada_coerce_ref (arr);
2148 /* If our value is a pointer, then dererence it. Make sure that
2149 this operation does not cause the target type to be fixed, as
2150 this would indirectly cause this array to be decoded. The rest
2151 of the routine assumes that the array hasn't been decoded yet,
2152 so we use the basic "value_ind" routine to perform the dereferencing,
2153 as opposed to using "ada_value_ind". */
2154 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2155 arr = value_ind (arr);
2157 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
2160 error (_("can't unpack array"));
2164 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (arr)))
2165 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
2167 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
2168 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
2169 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
2170 first left-justify it. */
2171 int bit_size, bit_pos;
2174 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
2181 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
2182 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
2183 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2184 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2189 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
2193 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
2194 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
2196 static struct value *
2197 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2200 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
2201 long elt_total_bit_offset;
2202 struct type *elt_type;
2206 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
2207 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2208 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
2210 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2211 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
2213 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of "
2214 "something other than a packed array"));
2217 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2218 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
2221 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
2223 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
2224 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
2227 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
2228 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
2229 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"),
2231 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
2232 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
2233 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2236 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2237 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2239 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
2244 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2247 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2249 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2254 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2255 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2256 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0;
2261 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2262 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2263 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2264 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2265 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2266 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2267 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2268 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2271 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2272 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2276 int src, /* Index into the source area */
2277 targ, /* Index into the target area */
2278 srcBitsLeft, /* Number of source bits left to move */
2279 nsrc, ntarg, /* Number of source and target bytes */
2280 unusedLS, /* Number of bits in next significant
2281 byte of source that are unused */
2282 accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2283 unsigned char *bytes; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2284 unsigned char *unpacked;
2285 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2287 int len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2288 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2289 the indices move. */
2290 int delta = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)) ? -1 : 1;
2292 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2296 v = allocate_value (type);
2297 bytes = (unsigned char *) (valaddr + offset);
2299 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2301 v = value_at (type, value_address (obj));
2302 bytes = (unsigned char *) alloca (len);
2303 read_memory (value_address (v) + offset, bytes, len);
2307 v = allocate_value (type);
2308 bytes = (unsigned char *) value_contents (obj) + offset;
2313 long new_offset = offset;
2315 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2316 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2317 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2318 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2321 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2323 set_value_offset (v, new_offset);
2325 /* Also set the parent value. This is needed when trying to
2326 assign a new value (in inferior memory). */
2327 set_value_parent (v, obj);
2331 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2332 unpacked = (unsigned char *) value_contents (v);
2334 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2336 ntarg = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
2340 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2343 else if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2346 if (has_negatives (type)
2347 && ((bytes[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2351 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2354 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2356 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
2357 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
2358 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
2359 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2361 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2362 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2364 targ = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2369 targ = TYPE_LENGTH (type) - 1;
2375 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2378 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2381 if (has_negatives (type) && (bytes[len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2388 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2389 part of the value. */
2390 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2391 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2393 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2394 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2397 (((bytes[src] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2398 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2399 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2401 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2402 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2403 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2407 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2414 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2415 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2416 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2417 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2425 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to
2426 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must
2429 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source,
2430 int src_offset, int n, int bits_big_endian_p)
2432 unsigned int accum, mask;
2433 int accum_bits, chunk_size;
2435 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2436 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2437 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2438 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2439 if (bits_big_endian_p)
2441 accum = (unsigned char) *source;
2443 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2449 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source;
2450 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2452 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2455 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset);
2456 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right;
2459 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask);
2461 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2468 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset;
2470 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2474 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits);
2475 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2477 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2480 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset;
2481 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask);
2483 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2484 accum >>= chunk_size;
2491 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2492 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2493 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2494 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2496 static struct value *
2497 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2499 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2500 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2502 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2503 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2505 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2506 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2507 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2508 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2510 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2511 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2513 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2515 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2516 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2518 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2519 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2521 char *buffer = (char *) alloca (len);
2523 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2525 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2526 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2528 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2529 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2531 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2532 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (type)))
2533 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2534 value_contents (fromval), from_size - bits, bits, 1);
2536 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2537 value_contents (fromval), 0, bits, 0);
2538 write_memory_with_notification (to_addr, buffer, len);
2540 val = value_copy (toval);
2541 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2542 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2543 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2548 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2552 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2553 * CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2554 * CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2555 * COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2556 * of COMPONENT are ignored. */
2558 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2561 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2562 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2563 int bit_offset_in_container =
2564 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2567 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2569 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2570 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2572 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2574 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (get_type_arch (value_type (container))))
2575 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2576 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2577 value_contents (val),
2578 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits,
2581 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2582 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2583 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2586 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2587 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2591 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2595 struct type *elt_type;
2597 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2599 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2600 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2601 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2602 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2604 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2606 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2607 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2608 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2613 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a standard GDB array of type TYPE, the
2614 value of the element of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in
2615 IND. Does not read the entire array into memory. */
2617 static struct value *
2618 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, struct type *type, int arity,
2623 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2627 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2628 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2629 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2631 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2632 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - lwb);
2633 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2636 return value_ind (arr);
2639 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2640 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of HIGH-LOW+1
2641 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of this array is LOW, as
2643 static struct value *
2644 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2647 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (type);
2648 CORE_ADDR base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2649 + ((low - ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)))
2650 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0)));
2651 struct type *index_type =
2652 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0)),
2654 struct type *slice_type =
2655 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), index_type);
2657 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2661 static struct value *
2662 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2664 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
2665 struct type *index_type =
2666 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2667 struct type *slice_type =
2668 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2670 return value_cast (slice_type, value_slice (array, low, high - low + 1));
2673 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2674 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2675 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2676 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2679 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2686 type = desc_base_type (type);
2689 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2690 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2692 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2695 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2701 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2702 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2703 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2704 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2707 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2709 type = desc_base_type (type);
2711 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2714 struct type *p_array_type;
2716 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2718 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2722 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2723 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2725 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2727 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2730 return p_array_type;
2732 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2734 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2736 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2745 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2746 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2747 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2748 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2749 the error message. */
2751 static struct type *
2752 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2754 struct type *result_type;
2756 type = desc_base_type (type);
2758 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2759 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2761 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2765 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2766 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2767 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2768 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2769 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2770 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2771 if (result_type && TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2776 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2777 if (result_type == NULL)
2778 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2784 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2785 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2786 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2787 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2788 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2791 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type * arr_type, int n, int which)
2793 struct type *type, *elt_type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2796 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2798 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2799 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2801 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2802 return (LONGEST) - which;
2804 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2805 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2810 for (i = n; i > 1; i--)
2811 elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2813 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2814 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
2815 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
2816 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2819 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2822 (LONGEST) (which == 0
2823 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type)
2824 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type));
2827 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
2828 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2829 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2830 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2833 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
2835 struct type *arr_type = value_type (arr);
2837 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2838 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
2839 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2840 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
2842 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
2845 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
2846 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2847 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
2848 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
2849 clauses at the moment. */
2852 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
2854 struct type *arr_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2856 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2857 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
2859 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2860 return (ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1)
2861 - ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0) + 1);
2863 return (value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1))
2864 - value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0)) + 1);
2867 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type),
2868 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */
2870 static struct value *
2871 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low)
2873 struct type *arr_type0 = ada_check_typedef (arr_type);
2874 struct type *index_type =
2875 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type0)),
2877 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type0, 1);
2879 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
2883 /* Name resolution */
2885 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
2889 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
2893 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
2895 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
2896 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
2898 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
2902 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
2903 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
2904 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
2905 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
2906 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
2907 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
2908 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
2909 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
2912 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p)
2914 struct type *context_type = NULL;
2918 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
2920 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type);
2923 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
2924 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
2925 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
2926 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
2927 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
2928 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
2929 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
2930 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
2932 static struct value *
2933 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
2934 struct type *context_type)
2938 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
2939 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
2940 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
2941 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
2948 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
2953 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2954 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2959 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2961 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
2966 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2971 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type));
2974 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
2984 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
2985 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
2991 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
2993 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
3002 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
3004 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
3006 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1));
3023 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
3024 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
3025 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3026 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3027 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3030 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3037 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
3045 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3061 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
3071 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3074 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
3075 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3088 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
3091 argvec = (struct value * *) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 1));
3092 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
3093 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
3097 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
3104 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3106 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3110 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
3111 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
3112 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3115 if (n_candidates > 1)
3117 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
3118 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
3121 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
3122 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym))
3127 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
3135 if (j < n_candidates)
3138 while (j < n_candidates)
3140 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
3142 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
3151 if (n_candidates == 0)
3152 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
3153 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3154 else if (n_candidates == 1)
3156 else if (deprocedure_p
3157 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates))
3159 i = ada_resolve_function
3160 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0,
3161 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
3164 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3165 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3169 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
3170 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
3171 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1);
3175 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
3176 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
3177 if (innermost_block == NULL
3178 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
3179 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
3183 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
3186 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0,
3187 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
3188 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
3195 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3196 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3198 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3202 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
3203 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
3204 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3206 if (n_candidates == 1)
3210 i = ada_resolve_function
3211 (candidates, n_candidates,
3213 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
3216 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3217 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
3220 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
3221 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
3222 if (innermost_block == NULL
3223 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
3224 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
3235 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3236 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3237 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3239 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3247 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3249 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3251 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3255 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)),
3256 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3258 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs,
3259 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL);
3263 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3264 candidates[i].sym, candidates[i].block);
3275 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3278 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3279 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3281 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3285 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3287 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3288 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3290 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3291 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3292 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3293 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3295 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
3298 return TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE (atype);
3300 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3301 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3302 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3305 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3307 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3308 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3309 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3312 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3313 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3319 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3320 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3321 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3323 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3324 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3325 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3326 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3328 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3329 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3331 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3333 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3337 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3338 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3339 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3340 argument function. */
3343 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3346 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3348 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3349 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3350 return (n_actuals == 0);
3351 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3354 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3357 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3359 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3363 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type,
3365 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3367 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3374 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3375 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3376 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3377 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3380 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3382 struct type *return_type;
3384 if (func_type == NULL)
3387 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3388 return_type = get_base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3390 return_type = get_base_type (func_type);
3391 if (return_type == NULL)
3394 context_type = get_base_type (context_type);
3396 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3397 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3398 else if (context_type == NULL)
3399 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3401 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3405 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3406 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3407 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3408 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3409 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3410 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3412 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3413 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3414 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3415 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3418 ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info syms[],
3419 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3420 const char *name, struct type *context_type)
3424 int m; /* Number of hits */
3427 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3428 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3429 where every function is accepted. */
3430 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3432 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3434 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].sym));
3436 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].sym, args, nargs)
3437 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3449 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3450 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3456 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3457 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3458 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3459 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3460 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3463 encoded_ordered_before (const char *N0, const char *N1)
3467 else if (N0 == NULL)
3473 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3475 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3477 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3478 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3483 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3486 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3488 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3489 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3491 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3495 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3499 sort_choices (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int nsyms)
3503 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3505 struct ada_symbol_info sym = syms[i];
3508 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3510 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
3511 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.sym)))
3513 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3519 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3520 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3521 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3524 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3525 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3528 user_select_syms (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3531 int *chosen = (int *) alloca (sizeof (int) * nsyms);
3533 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3534 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3536 if (max_results < 1)
3537 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3541 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3543 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3544 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3546 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3547 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3548 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3549 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3552 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3553 if (max_results > 1)
3554 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n"));
3556 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3558 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3560 if (syms[i].sym == NULL)
3563 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_BLOCK)
3565 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3566 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].sym, 1);
3568 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3569 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at <no source file available>:%d\n"),
3571 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3574 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"), i + first_choice,
3575 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3576 sal.symtab->filename, sal.line);
3582 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_CONST
3583 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym) != NULL
3584 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3585 struct symtab *symtab = syms[i].sym->symtab;
3587 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3588 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"),
3590 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3591 symtab->filename, SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym));
3592 else if (is_enumeral
3593 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != NULL)
3595 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3596 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym), NULL,
3598 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3599 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3601 else if (symtab != NULL)
3602 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3603 ? _("[%d] %s in %s (enumeral)\n")
3604 : _("[%d] %s at %s:?\n"),
3606 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3609 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3610 ? _("[%d] %s (enumeral)\n")
3611 : _("[%d] %s at ?\n"),
3613 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3617 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3620 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3621 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3626 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3627 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3628 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3630 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3631 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3633 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3634 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3635 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3637 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3639 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3640 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3643 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3644 int is_all_choice, char *annotation_suffix)
3649 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3651 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3655 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix);
3658 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3662 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3663 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3669 args = skip_spaces (args);
3670 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3671 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3672 else if (*args == '\0')
3675 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3676 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3677 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3678 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3682 error (_("cancelled"));
3684 if (choice < first_choice)
3686 n_chosen = n_choices;
3687 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3691 choice -= first_choice;
3693 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3697 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3701 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3702 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3703 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3708 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3709 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3714 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3715 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3716 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3719 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs,
3720 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
3721 struct block *block)
3723 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
3724 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
3725 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
3726 xzalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
3727 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
3728 struct expression *exp = *expp;
3730 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
3731 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
3732 newexp->gdbarch = exp->gdbarch;
3733 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
3734 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
3735 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
3737 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
3738 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
3740 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
3741 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
3742 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
3748 /* Type-class predicates */
3750 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
3754 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
3760 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3765 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3766 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3767 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3774 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
3777 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
3783 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3787 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3788 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3789 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3796 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
3799 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
3805 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3808 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3809 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3818 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
3821 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
3827 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3830 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3831 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3832 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
3840 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
3841 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
3842 (i.e., result 0). */
3845 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
3847 struct type *type0 =
3848 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
3849 struct type *type1 =
3850 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
3864 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
3868 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3869 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3870 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3871 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3874 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3879 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
3882 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
3885 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3889 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3891 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
3900 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
3901 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
3903 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
3904 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
3905 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
3906 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
3907 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
3908 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
3910 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
3912 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
3914 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
3915 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
3916 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
3917 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
3918 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
3919 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
3920 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
3921 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
3922 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
3923 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
3924 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
3925 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
3927 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
3929 enum ada_renaming_category
3930 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
3931 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3932 const char **renaming_expr)
3934 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3939 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3940 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
3943 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3945 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym),
3946 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr);
3950 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
3951 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR");
3953 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3957 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3961 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3965 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3969 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3973 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3977 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3978 *renamed_entity = info;
3979 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3980 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3981 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3983 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
3985 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3986 *renaming_expr = suffix;
3990 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in
3991 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY,
3992 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns
3993 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */
3994 static enum ada_renaming_category
3995 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type,
3996 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3997 const char **renaming_expr)
3999 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
4004 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4005 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1)
4006 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4008 name = type_name_no_tag (type);
4010 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4012 name = strstr (name, "___XR");
4014 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4019 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
4022 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
4025 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
4028 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
4031 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4034 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0);
4036 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4037 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
4038 *renamed_entity = info;
4039 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
4040 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
4041 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5;
4042 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
4043 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4045 *len = suffix - info;
4049 /* Compute the value of the given RENAMING_SYM, which is expected to
4050 be a symbol encoding a renaming expression. BLOCK is the block
4051 used to evaluate the renaming. */
4053 static struct value *
4054 ada_read_renaming_var_value (struct symbol *renaming_sym,
4055 struct block *block)
4058 struct expression *expr;
4059 struct value *value;
4060 struct cleanup *old_chain = NULL;
4062 sym_name = xstrdup (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (renaming_sym));
4063 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, sym_name);
4064 expr = parse_exp_1 (&sym_name, 0, block, 0);
4065 make_cleanup (free_current_contents, &expr);
4066 value = evaluate_expression (expr);
4068 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4073 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
4075 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
4076 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of allocating memory
4077 in the inferior where a copy of the value contents is copied. */
4079 static struct value *
4080 ensure_lval (struct value *val)
4082 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == not_lval
4083 || VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_internalvar)
4085 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
4086 const CORE_ADDR addr =
4087 value_as_long (value_allocate_space_in_inferior (len));
4089 set_value_address (val, addr);
4090 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
4091 write_memory (addr, value_contents (val), len);
4097 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
4098 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
4099 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
4100 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
4103 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0)
4105 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4106 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
4107 struct type *formal_target =
4108 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4109 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
4110 struct type *actual_target =
4111 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4112 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
4114 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
4115 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
4116 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual);
4117 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4118 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4120 struct value *result;
4122 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
4123 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
4124 result = desc_data (actual);
4125 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4127 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
4131 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4132 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
4133 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
4134 (char *) value_contents (actual),
4135 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
4136 actual = ensure_lval (val);
4138 result = value_addr (actual);
4142 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result, 0);
4144 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4145 return ada_value_ind (actual);
4150 /* Convert VALUE (which must be an address) to a CORE_ADDR that is a pointer of
4151 type TYPE. This is usually an inefficient no-op except on some targets
4152 (such as AVR) where the representation of a pointer and an address
4156 value_pointer (struct value *value, struct type *type)
4158 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_type_arch (type);
4159 unsigned len = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
4160 gdb_byte *buf = alloca (len);
4163 addr = value_address (value);
4164 gdbarch_address_to_pointer (gdbarch, type, buf, addr);
4165 addr = extract_unsigned_integer (buf, len, gdbarch_byte_order (gdbarch));
4170 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
4171 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
4172 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
4173 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
4174 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
4176 static struct value *
4177 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr)
4179 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
4180 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
4181 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
4182 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
4185 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)));
4188 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4189 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
4190 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
4191 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
4192 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4193 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
4194 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
4195 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
4198 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds);
4200 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4201 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4202 value_pointer (ensure_lval (arr),
4203 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 0)),
4204 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
4205 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
4207 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4208 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4209 value_pointer (bounds,
4210 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 1)),
4211 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
4212 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
4214 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor);
4216 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4217 return value_addr (descriptor);
4222 /* Dummy definitions for an experimental caching module that is not
4223 * used in the public sources. */
4226 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4227 struct symbol **sym, struct block **block)
4233 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace, struct symbol *sym,
4234 struct block *block)
4240 /* Return nonzero if wild matching should be used when searching for
4241 all symbols matching LOOKUP_NAME.
4243 LOOKUP_NAME is expected to be a symbol name after transformation
4244 for Ada lookups (see ada_name_for_lookup). */
4247 should_use_wild_match (const char *lookup_name)
4249 return (strstr (lookup_name, "__") == NULL);
4252 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
4253 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
4255 static struct symbol *
4256 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
4259 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
4260 struct symbol *sym = NULL;
4262 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, NULL))
4264 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0);
4265 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym, block_found);
4270 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
4271 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
4272 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
4274 is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int n)
4278 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4279 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4280 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4281 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) != LOC_CONST))
4287 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4288 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4291 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4295 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4296 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
4298 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4299 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4300 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4301 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4307 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4308 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4311 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4315 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4316 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4319 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4325 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4326 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4327 const char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0);
4328 const char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1);
4329 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4332 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
4333 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4334 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4335 && strncmp (name1 + len0, "___XV", 5) == 0));
4338 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4339 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4345 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct ada_symbol_info
4346 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4349 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4351 struct block *block)
4354 struct ada_symbol_info *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4356 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4357 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4358 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4359 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4360 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4361 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4362 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4363 out the stub ones if needed. */
4365 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4367 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].sym))
4369 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].sym, sym))
4371 prevDefns[i].sym = sym;
4372 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4378 struct ada_symbol_info info;
4382 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
4386 /* Number of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in
4387 current vector in *OBSTACKP. */
4390 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4392 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info);
4395 /* Vector of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in current
4396 vector in *OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return
4397 its final address. */
4399 static struct ada_symbol_info *
4400 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4403 return obstack_finish (obstackp);
4405 return (struct ada_symbol_info *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4408 /* Return a minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada decoding
4409 rules. Returns NULL if there is no such minimal symbol. Names
4410 prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__" is
4411 first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4413 struct minimal_symbol *
4414 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4416 struct objfile *objfile;
4417 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4418 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name);
4420 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
4421 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
4422 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
4423 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
4424 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
4425 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
4426 entity inside its program). */
4427 if (strncmp (name, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4428 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4430 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4432 if (match_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match_p)
4433 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4440 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4441 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4442 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4443 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD_MATCH_P, treat as NAME
4444 with a wildcard prefix. */
4447 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4448 const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4453 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4454 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4457 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4459 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4461 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4464 /* Return nonzero if TYPE1 and TYPE2 are two enumeration types
4465 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes.
4467 This function assumes that TYPE1 and TYPE2 are both TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4468 types and that their number of enumerals is identical (in other
4469 words, TYPE_NFIELDS (type1) == TYPE_NFIELDS (type2)). */
4472 ada_identical_enum_types_p (struct type *type1, struct type *type2)
4476 /* The heuristic we use here is fairly conservative. We consider
4477 that 2 enumerate types are identical if they have the same
4478 number of enumerals and that all enumerals have the same
4479 underlying value and name. */
4481 /* All enums in the type should have an identical underlying value. */
4482 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4483 if (TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type1, i) != TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type2, i))
4486 /* All enumerals should also have the same name (modulo any numerical
4488 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4490 const char *name_1 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i);
4491 const char *name_2 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i);
4492 int len_1 = strlen (name_1);
4493 int len_2 = strlen (name_2);
4495 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), &len_1);
4496 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), &len_2);
4498 || strncmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i),
4499 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i),
4507 /* Return nonzero if all the symbols in SYMS are all enumeral symbols
4508 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. Sometimes,
4509 enumerals are not strictly identical, but their types are so similar
4510 that they can be considered identical.
4512 For instance, consider the following code:
4514 type Color is (Black, Red, Green, Blue, White);
4515 type RGB_Color is new Color range Red .. Blue;
4517 Type RGB_Color is a subrange of an implicit type which is a copy
4518 of type Color. If we call that implicit type RGB_ColorB ("B" is
4519 for "Base Type"), then type RGB_ColorB is a copy of type Color.
4520 As a result, when an expression references any of the enumeral
4521 by name (Eg. "print green"), the expression is technically
4522 ambiguous and the user should be asked to disambiguate. But
4523 doing so would only hinder the user, since it wouldn't matter
4524 what choice he makes, the outcome would always be the same.
4525 So, for practical purposes, we consider them as the same. */
4528 symbols_are_identical_enums (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4532 /* Before performing a thorough comparison check of each type,
4533 we perform a series of inexpensive checks. We expect that these
4534 checks will quickly fail in the vast majority of cases, and thus
4535 help prevent the unnecessary use of a more expensive comparison.
4536 Said comparison also expects us to make some of these checks
4537 (see ada_identical_enum_types_p). */
4539 /* Quick check: All symbols should have an enum type. */
4540 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i++)
4541 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4544 /* Quick check: They should all have the same value. */
4545 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4546 if (SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[i].sym) != SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[0].sym))
4549 /* Quick check: They should all have the same number of enumerals. */
4550 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4551 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4552 != TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].sym)))
4555 /* All the sanity checks passed, so we might have a set of
4556 identical enumeration types. Perform a more complete
4557 comparison of the type of each symbol. */
4558 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i++)
4559 if (!ada_identical_enum_types_p (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym),
4560 SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].sym)))
4566 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely
4567 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
4568 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
4569 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
4570 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
4571 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
4574 remove_extra_symbols (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4578 /* We should never be called with less than 2 symbols, as there
4579 cannot be any extra symbol in that case. But it's easy to
4580 handle, since we have nothing to do in that case. */
4589 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
4590 the get rid of the stub. */
4592 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym))
4593 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL)
4595 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j++)
4598 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[j].sym))
4599 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4600 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4601 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0)
4606 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
4607 should be identical. */
4609 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL
4610 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_STATIC
4611 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)))
4613 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4616 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4617 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4618 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0
4619 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].sym)
4620 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].sym)
4621 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].sym))
4628 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4629 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4636 /* If all the remaining symbols are identical enumerals, then
4637 just keep the first one and discard the rest.
4639 Unlike what we did previously, we do not discard any entry
4640 unless they are ALL identical. This is because the symbol
4641 comparison is not a strict comparison, but rather a practical
4642 comparison. If all symbols are considered identical, then
4643 we can just go ahead and use the first one and discard the rest.
4644 But if we cannot reduce the list to a single element, we have
4645 to ask the user to disambiguate anyways. And if we have to
4646 present a multiple-choice menu, it's less confusing if the list
4647 isn't missing some choices that were identical and yet distinct. */
4648 if (symbols_are_identical_enums (syms, nsyms))
4654 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
4655 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
4656 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
4657 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */
4660 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
4662 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
4663 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
4664 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
4665 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
4667 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type);
4668 char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4673 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
4674 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
4676 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
4677 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
4680 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
4682 scope_len = last - name;
4683 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
4685 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len);
4686 scope[scope_len] = '\0';
4691 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
4694 is_package_name (const char *name)
4696 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
4697 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
4698 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
4699 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
4700 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
4704 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
4705 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
4706 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
4709 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
4710 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
4712 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
4713 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
4714 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
4717 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name);
4719 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
4722 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
4723 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
4726 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, const char *function_name)
4730 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
4733 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
4735 make_cleanup (xfree, scope);
4737 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
4738 if (is_package_name (scope))
4741 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
4742 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
4744 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
4745 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
4746 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
4748 if (strncmp (function_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
4751 return (strncmp (function_name, scope, strlen (scope)) != 0);
4754 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
4755 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
4756 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
4757 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
4758 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
4761 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
4762 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
4763 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
4766 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
4767 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
4768 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
4769 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
4770 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
4771 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
4772 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
4774 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
4775 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
4776 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
4777 method with the current information available. The implementation
4778 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
4780 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
4781 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
4782 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
4783 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
4784 currently not the case.
4786 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
4787 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
4788 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
4789 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
4792 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct ada_symbol_info *syms,
4793 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block)
4795 struct symbol *current_function;
4796 const char *current_function_name;
4798 int is_new_style_renaming;
4800 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
4801 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
4802 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
4803 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
4804 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
4806 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].sym;
4807 struct block *block = syms[i].block;
4811 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
4813 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym);
4814 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4818 int name_len = suffix - name;
4821 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
4822 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4823 if (i != j && syms[j].sym != NULL
4824 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
4826 && block == syms[j].block)
4830 if (is_new_style_renaming)
4834 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4835 if (syms[j].sym != NULL)
4843 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
4844 Abort if unable to do so. */
4846 if (current_block == NULL)
4849 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
4850 if (current_function == NULL)
4853 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function);
4854 if (current_function_name == NULL)
4857 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
4858 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
4859 the current block. */
4864 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].sym, NULL, NULL, NULL)
4865 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
4866 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].sym, current_function_name))
4870 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4871 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4881 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
4882 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
4883 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
4884 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
4885 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
4886 If WILD_MATCH_P is nonzero, perform the naming matching in
4887 "wild" mode (see function "wild_match" for more info).
4889 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
4892 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
4893 struct block *block, domain_enum domain,
4896 int block_depth = 0;
4898 while (block != NULL)
4901 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, name, domain, NULL,
4904 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
4905 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
4906 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
4909 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
4912 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
4913 enclosing subprogram. */
4914 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
4915 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, name, domain, wild_match_p);
4918 /* An object of this type is used as the user_data argument when
4919 calling the map_matching_symbols method. */
4923 struct objfile *objfile;
4924 struct obstack *obstackp;
4925 struct symbol *arg_sym;
4929 /* A callback for add_matching_symbols that adds SYM, found in BLOCK,
4930 to a list of symbols. DATA0 is a pointer to a struct match_data *
4931 containing the obstack that collects the symbol list, the file that SYM
4932 must come from, a flag indicating whether a non-argument symbol has
4933 been found in the current block, and the last argument symbol
4934 passed in SYM within the current block (if any). When SYM is null,
4935 marking the end of a block, the argument symbol is added if no
4936 other has been found. */
4939 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (struct block *block, struct symbol *sym, void *data0)
4941 struct match_data *data = (struct match_data *) data0;
4945 if (!data->found_sym && data->arg_sym != NULL)
4946 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
4947 fixup_symbol_section (data->arg_sym, data->objfile),
4949 data->found_sym = 0;
4950 data->arg_sym = NULL;
4954 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
4956 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
4957 data->arg_sym = sym;
4960 data->found_sym = 1;
4961 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
4962 fixup_symbol_section (sym, data->objfile),
4969 /* Compare STRING1 to STRING2, with results as for strcmp.
4970 Compatible with strcmp_iw in that strcmp_iw (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
4971 implies compare_names (STRING1, STRING2) (they may differ as to
4972 what symbols compare equal). */
4975 compare_names (const char *string1, const char *string2)
4977 while (*string1 != '\0' && *string2 != '\0')
4979 if (isspace (*string1) || isspace (*string2))
4980 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
4981 if (*string1 != *string2)
4989 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
4991 if (*string2 == '\0')
4993 if (is_name_suffix (string1))
5000 if (*string2 == '(')
5001 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5003 return *string1 - *string2;
5007 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
5008 NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on GLOBAL_BLOCK
5009 symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK symbols otherwise. */
5012 add_nonlocal_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp, const char *name,
5013 domain_enum domain, int global,
5016 struct objfile *objfile;
5017 struct match_data data;
5019 memset (&data, 0, sizeof data);
5020 data.obstackp = obstackp;
5022 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
5024 data.objfile = objfile;
5027 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (name, domain, objfile, global,
5028 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data,
5031 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (name, domain, objfile, global,
5032 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols, &data,
5033 full_match, compare_names);
5036 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && global && !is_wild_match)
5038 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
5040 char *name1 = alloca (strlen (name) + sizeof ("_ada_"));
5041 strcpy (name1, "_ada_");
5042 strcpy (name1 + sizeof ("_ada_") - 1, name);
5043 data.objfile = objfile;
5044 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (name1, domain,
5046 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols,
5048 full_match, compare_names);
5053 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
5054 scope and in global scopes, returning the number of matches.
5055 Sets *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples,
5056 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if
5057 any) in which they were found. This vector are transient---good only to
5058 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list. Any non-function/non-enumeral
5059 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK0,
5060 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5061 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5062 surrounding BLOCK0, then these alone are returned. Otherwise, if
5063 FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, then the search extends to global and
5064 file-scope (static) symbol tables.
5065 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
5066 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
5069 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
5070 domain_enum namespace,
5071 struct ada_symbol_info **results,
5075 struct block *block;
5077 const int wild_match_p = should_use_wild_match (name0);
5081 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL);
5082 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
5086 /* Search specified block and its superiors. */
5089 block = (struct block *) block0; /* FIXME: No cast ought to be
5090 needed, but adding const will
5091 have a cascade effect. */
5093 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
5094 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
5095 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
5096 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
5097 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
5098 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
5099 entity inside its program). */
5100 if (strncmp (name0, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
5103 name = name0 + sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
5106 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
5108 ada_add_local_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, block, namespace,
5110 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) > 0 || !full_search)
5113 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
5114 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
5118 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name0, namespace, &sym, &block))
5121 add_defn_to_vec (&symbol_list_obstack, sym, block);
5125 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
5127 add_nonlocal_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 1,
5130 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
5131 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
5133 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0)
5134 add_nonlocal_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, name, namespace, 0,
5138 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
5139 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1);
5141 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns);
5143 if (ndefns == 0 && full_search)
5144 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, NULL, NULL);
5146 if (ndefns == 1 && full_search && cacheIfUnique)
5147 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, (*results)[0].sym, (*results)[0].block);
5149 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block0);
5154 /* If NAME is the name of an entity, return a string that should
5155 be used to look that entity up in Ada units. This string should
5156 be deallocated after use using xfree.
5158 NAME can have any form that the "break" or "print" commands might
5159 recognize. In other words, it does not have to be the "natural"
5160 name, or the "encoded" name. */
5163 ada_name_for_lookup (const char *name)
5166 int nlen = strlen (name);
5168 if (name[0] == '<' && name[nlen - 1] == '>')
5170 canon = xmalloc (nlen - 1);
5171 memcpy (canon, name + 1, nlen - 2);
5172 canon[nlen - 2] = '\0';
5175 canon = xstrdup (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)));
5179 /* Implementation of the la_iterate_over_symbols method. */
5182 ada_iterate_over_symbols (const struct block *block,
5183 const char *name, domain_enum domain,
5184 symbol_found_callback_ftype *callback,
5188 struct ada_symbol_info *results;
5190 ndefs = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block, domain, &results, 0);
5191 for (i = 0; i < ndefs; ++i)
5193 if (! (*callback) (results[i].sym, data))
5198 /* The result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list with FULL_SEARCH set
5199 to 1, but choosing the first symbol found if there are multiple
5202 The result is stored in *INFO, which must be non-NULL.
5203 If no match is found, INFO->SYM is set to NULL. */
5206 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5207 domain_enum namespace,
5208 struct ada_symbol_info *info)
5210 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
5213 gdb_assert (info != NULL);
5214 memset (info, 0, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
5216 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block, namespace, &candidates,
5219 if (n_candidates == 0)
5222 *info = candidates[0];
5223 info->sym = fixup_symbol_section (info->sym, NULL);
5226 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
5227 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
5228 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
5229 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices.
5230 If IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is not NULL, it is set to zero. */
5233 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
5234 domain_enum namespace, int *is_a_field_of_this)
5236 struct ada_symbol_info info;
5238 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL)
5239 *is_a_field_of_this = 0;
5241 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)),
5242 block0, namespace, &info);
5246 static struct symbol *
5247 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const char *name,
5248 const struct block *block,
5249 const domain_enum domain)
5251 return ada_lookup_symbol (name, block_static_block (block), domain, NULL);
5255 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
5256 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
5257 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
5258 are given by any of the regular expressions:
5260 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
5261 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
5262 TKB [subprogram suffix for task bodies]
5263 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
5264 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
5266 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
5267 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
5268 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
5271 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
5274 const char *matching;
5275 const int len = strlen (str);
5277 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
5279 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
5282 while (isdigit (str[0]))
5288 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
5291 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5293 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5299 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
5302 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5304 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5308 /* "TKB" suffixes are used for subprograms implementing task bodies. */
5310 if (strcmp (str, "TKB") == 0)
5314 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
5315 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
5316 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
5317 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
5318 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
5319 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
5321 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
5322 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
5323 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
5324 the following check. */
5325 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
5326 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
5331 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
5334 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5336 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
5337 && matching [1] == '\0')
5341 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
5342 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
5343 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
5344 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
5345 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
5349 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
5351 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
5357 if (str[0] == '\000')
5362 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
5366 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
5368 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
5369 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
5370 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
5371 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
5372 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
5373 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
5377 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
5378 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
5380 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
5384 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
5386 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5387 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5391 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
5393 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5394 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5401 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
5402 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
5405 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
5407 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
5410 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
5411 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
5412 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
5413 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
5416 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
5417 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
5423 /* Advance *NAMEP to next occurrence of TARGET0 in the string NAME0
5424 that could start a simple name. Assumes that *NAMEP points into
5425 the string beginning at NAME0. */
5428 advance_wild_match (const char **namep, const char *name0, int target0)
5430 const char *name = *namep;
5440 if ((t1 >= 'a' && t1 <= 'z') || (t1 >= '0' && t1 <= '9'))
5443 if (name == name0 + 5 && strncmp (name0, "_ada", 4) == 0)
5448 else if (t1 == '_' && ((name[2] >= 'a' && name[2] <= 'z')
5449 || name[2] == target0))
5457 else if ((t0 >= 'a' && t0 <= 'z') || (t0 >= '0' && t0 <= '9'))
5467 /* Return 0 iff NAME encodes a name of the form prefix.PATN. Ignores any
5468 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is
5469 true). Assumes that PATN is a lower-cased Ada simple name. */
5472 wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn)
5475 const char *name0 = name;
5479 const char *match = name;
5483 for (name += 1, p = patn + 1; *p != '\0'; name += 1, p += 1)
5486 if (*p == '\0' && is_name_suffix (name))
5487 return match != name0 && !is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0);
5489 if (name[-1] == '_')
5492 if (!advance_wild_match (&name, name0, *patn))
5497 /* Returns 0 iff symbol name SYM_NAME matches SEARCH_NAME, apart from
5498 informational suffix. */
5501 full_match (const char *sym_name, const char *search_name)
5503 return !match_name (sym_name, search_name, 0);
5507 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to
5508 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP
5509 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix.
5510 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK.
5511 SYMTAB is recorded with each symbol added. */
5514 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5515 struct block *block, const char *name,
5516 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile,
5519 struct block_iterator iter;
5520 int name_len = strlen (name);
5521 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
5522 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5523 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
5531 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, name, wild_match, &iter);
5532 sym != NULL; sym = block_iter_match_next (name, wild_match, &iter))
5534 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5535 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)
5536 && wild_match (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name) == 0)
5538 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5540 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5545 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5546 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5554 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, name, full_match, &iter);
5555 sym != NULL; sym = block_iter_match_next (name, full_match, &iter))
5557 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5558 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5560 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5562 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5567 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5568 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5576 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5578 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5579 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5588 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5590 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5591 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5595 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0];
5598 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 5);
5600 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5,
5605 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5))
5607 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5609 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5614 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5615 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5623 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
5624 They aren't parameters, right? */
5625 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5627 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5628 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5635 /* Symbol Completion */
5637 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol
5638 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result
5639 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call.
5641 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT.
5642 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH_P is set.
5643 ENCODED_P should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name
5644 in its encoded form. */
5647 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name,
5648 const char *text, int text_len,
5649 int wild_match_p, int encoded_p)
5651 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<');
5656 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */
5661 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
5663 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5666 if (match && !encoded_p)
5668 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
5669 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
5670 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
5671 is not a suitable completion. */
5672 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name;
5673 int has_angle_bracket;
5675 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5676 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<');
5677 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match);
5678 sym_name = sym_name_copy;
5681 if (match && !verbatim_match)
5683 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
5684 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
5685 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
5686 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
5687 angle bracket notation. */
5690 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
5695 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
5697 if (!match && wild_match_p)
5699 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
5700 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
5701 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
5702 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name));
5704 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5708 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */
5714 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
5717 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5722 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list().
5723 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable
5724 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case
5725 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV.
5727 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command
5728 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which
5729 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to
5730 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the
5732 if WILD_MATCH_P is set, then wild matching is performed.
5733 ENCODED_P should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its
5734 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be
5738 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv,
5739 const char *sym_name,
5740 const char *text, int text_len,
5741 const char *orig_text, const char *word,
5742 int wild_match_p, int encoded_p)
5744 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len,
5745 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
5751 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given
5754 if (word == orig_text)
5756 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5757 strcpy (completion, match);
5759 else if (word > orig_text)
5761 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */
5762 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5763 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text));
5767 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */
5768 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5);
5769 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word);
5770 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0';
5771 strcat (completion, match);
5774 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion);
5777 /* An object of this type is passed as the user_data argument to the
5778 expand_partial_symbol_names method. */
5779 struct add_partial_datum
5781 VEC(char_ptr) **completions;
5790 /* A callback for expand_partial_symbol_names. */
5792 ada_expand_partial_symbol_name (const char *name, void *user_data)
5794 struct add_partial_datum *data = user_data;
5796 return symbol_completion_match (name, data->text, data->text_len,
5797 data->wild_match, data->encoded) != NULL;
5800 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. WORD is
5801 the entire command on which completion is made. */
5803 static VEC (char_ptr) *
5804 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (char *text0, char *word)
5810 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128);
5813 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
5814 struct objfile *objfile;
5815 struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
5817 struct block_iterator iter;
5819 if (text0[0] == '<')
5821 text = xstrdup (text0);
5822 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5823 text_len = strlen (text);
5829 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0));
5830 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5831 text_len = strlen (text);
5832 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++)
5833 text[i] = tolower (text[i]);
5835 encoded_p = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL);
5836 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
5837 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
5838 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like
5839 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */
5840 wild_match_p = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded_p);
5843 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
5845 struct add_partial_datum data;
5847 data.completions = &completions;
5849 data.text_len = text_len;
5852 data.wild_match = wild_match_p;
5853 data.encoded = encoded_p;
5854 expand_partial_symbol_names (ada_expand_partial_symbol_name, &data);
5857 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
5858 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
5859 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
5860 handled by the psymtab code above). */
5862 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
5865 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
5866 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match_p,
5870 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
5871 complete on local vars. */
5873 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5875 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5876 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
5878 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5880 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5881 text, text_len, text0, word,
5882 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
5886 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
5887 symbols which match. */
5889 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5892 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5893 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5895 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5896 text, text_len, text0, word,
5897 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
5901 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5904 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
5905 /* Don't do this block twice. */
5906 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
5908 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5910 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5911 text, text_len, text0, word,
5912 wild_match_p, encoded_p);
5921 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
5922 for tagged types. */
5925 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
5929 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5932 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5936 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5939 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
5940 to be invisible to users. */
5943 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5945 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
5948 /* Check the name of that field. */
5950 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5952 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
5953 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
5954 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */
5958 /* Normally, fields whose name start with an underscore ("_")
5959 are fields that have been internally generated by the compiler,
5960 and thus should not be printed. The "_parent" field is special,
5961 however: This is a field internally generated by the compiler
5962 for tagged types, and it contains the components inherited from
5963 the parent type. This field should not be printed as is, but
5964 should not be ignored either. */
5965 if (name[0] == '_' && strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) != 0)
5969 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type, then ignore. */
5970 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
5971 && ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num)))
5974 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
5978 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
5979 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
5982 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
5984 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL);
5987 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
5990 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
5992 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5996 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5998 return (name != NULL
5999 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6003 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
6006 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
6008 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL);
6011 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
6014 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
6016 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
6019 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
6020 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
6023 static struct value *
6024 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
6025 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6028 int tag_byte_offset;
6029 struct type *tag_type;
6031 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
6034 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
6036 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
6037 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
6039 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
6044 static struct type *
6045 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6047 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
6049 if (type_name != NULL)
6050 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
6054 /* Return the "ada__tags__type_specific_data" type. */
6056 static struct type *
6057 ada_get_tsd_type (struct inferior *inf)
6059 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (inf);
6061 if (data->tsd_type == 0)
6062 data->tsd_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
6063 return data->tsd_type;
6066 /* Return the TSD (type-specific data) associated to the given TAG.
6067 TAG is assumed to be the tag of a tagged-type entity.
6069 May return NULL if we are unable to get the TSD. */
6071 static struct value *
6072 ada_get_tsd_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6077 /* First option: The TSD is simply stored as a field of our TAG.
6078 Only older versions of GNAT would use this format, but we have
6079 to test it first, because there are no visible markers for
6080 the current approach except the absence of that field. */
6082 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1);
6086 /* Try the second representation for the dispatch table (in which
6087 there is no explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer,
6088 and instead the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch
6091 type = ada_get_tsd_type (current_inferior());
6094 type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (type));
6095 val = value_cast (type, tag);
6098 return value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -1));
6101 /* Given the TSD of a tag (type-specific data), return a string
6102 containing the name of the associated type.
6104 The returned value is good until the next call. May return NULL
6105 if we are unable to determine the tag name. */
6108 ada_tag_name_from_tsd (struct value *tsd)
6110 static char name[1024];
6114 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tsd, "expanded_name", 1);
6117 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
6118 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
6124 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
6127 Return NULL if the TAG is not an Ada tag, or if we were unable to
6128 determine the name of that tag. The result is good until the next
6132 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
6134 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
6137 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
6140 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while trying
6141 to determine the TAG's name, even under normal circumstances:
6142 The associated variable may be uninitialized or corrupted, for
6143 instance. We do not let any exception propagate past this point.
6144 instead we return NULL.
6146 We also do not print the error message either (which often is very
6147 low-level (Eg: "Cannot read memory at 0x[...]"), but instead let
6148 the caller print a more meaningful message if necessary. */
6149 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
6151 struct value *tsd = ada_get_tsd_from_tag (tag);
6154 name = ada_tag_name_from_tsd (tsd);
6160 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
6163 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
6167 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6169 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6172 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6173 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
6175 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6177 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
6178 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6179 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
6180 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
6181 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
6183 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
6189 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
6190 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
6191 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6194 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6196 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
6198 return (name != NULL
6199 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
6200 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0));
6203 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
6204 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
6205 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
6206 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
6210 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6212 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6214 return (name != NULL
6215 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
6216 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
6217 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0
6218 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
6221 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
6222 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
6223 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6226 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
6228 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
6230 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
6231 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
6232 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
6233 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
6236 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
6237 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
6238 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
6239 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
6242 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6244 char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6246 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL);
6249 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
6250 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
6251 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
6254 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
6256 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6258 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
6261 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
6262 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
6263 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
6266 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
6268 static char *result = NULL;
6269 static size_t result_len = 0;
6272 const char *discrim_end;
6273 const char *discrim_start;
6275 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6276 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
6280 name = ada_type_name (type);
6282 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
6285 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
6288 if (strncmp (discrim_end, "___XVN", 6) == 0)
6291 if (discrim_end == name)
6294 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
6297 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
6299 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
6300 && strncmp (discrim_start - 3, "___", 3) == 0)
6301 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
6305 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
6306 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
6307 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
6311 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
6312 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
6313 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
6314 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
6315 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
6316 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
6317 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
6320 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
6324 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
6327 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
6328 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
6331 while (isdigit (str[k]))
6333 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
6340 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
6346 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
6347 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
6348 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
6349 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
6350 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
6357 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
6358 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
6359 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
6362 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
6364 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6378 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
6388 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
6389 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
6391 if (val >= L && val <= U)
6403 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
6405 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
6406 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
6407 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
6408 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
6410 static struct value *
6411 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
6412 struct type *arg_type)
6416 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
6417 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
6419 /* Handle packed fields. */
6421 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0)
6423 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
6424 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
6426 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
6427 offset + bit_pos / 8,
6428 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
6431 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
6434 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
6435 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
6436 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
6437 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
6438 an object of that type;
6439 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
6440 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
6442 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
6443 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
6444 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
6445 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
6447 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
6450 find_struct_field (const char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
6451 struct type **field_type_p,
6452 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
6457 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6459 if (field_type_p != NULL)
6460 *field_type_p = NULL;
6461 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
6463 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
6465 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
6468 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6470 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
6471 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
6472 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6474 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6477 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6479 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
6481 if (field_type_p != NULL)
6482 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6483 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
6484 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
6485 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
6486 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
6487 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
6488 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
6491 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6493 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
6494 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
6495 bit_size_p, index_p))
6498 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6500 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
6503 struct type *field_type
6504 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6506 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6508 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6510 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6511 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
6512 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
6516 else if (index_p != NULL)
6522 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
6525 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
6530 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
6534 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
6535 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6536 If found, return value, else return NULL.
6538 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */
6540 static struct value *
6541 ada_search_struct_field (char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
6546 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6547 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6549 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6551 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6554 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6555 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6557 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6559 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6560 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
6561 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6562 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6568 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6570 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
6572 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
6574 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6576 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6578 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line
6581 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6582 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6592 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
6593 int, struct type *);
6596 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
6597 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
6598 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6599 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
6601 static struct value *
6602 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
6605 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
6609 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
6610 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
6613 static struct value *
6614 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
6618 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6620 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6622 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
6624 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6626 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6627 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
6628 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6629 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6635 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6637 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
6638 find_struct_field. */
6639 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
6641 else if (*index_p == 0)
6642 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6649 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
6650 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
6651 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
6654 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
6655 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
6658 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
6662 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, char *name, int no_err)
6664 struct type *t, *t1;
6668 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
6669 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6671 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6674 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6675 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6677 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
6682 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6684 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6687 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6688 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6690 arg = value_ind (arg);
6697 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
6701 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
6704 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
6705 struct type *field_type;
6708 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6709 address = value_as_address (arg);
6711 address = unpack_pointer (t, value_contents (arg));
6713 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1);
6714 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
6715 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
6720 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6721 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
6723 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
6724 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
6725 bit_offset, bit_size,
6729 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
6733 if (v != NULL || no_err)
6736 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
6742 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of "
6743 "a value that is not a record."));
6746 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
6747 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
6748 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
6749 work for packed fields).
6751 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
6754 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
6755 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
6756 ultimate target type will be searched.
6758 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
6760 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
6761 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
6763 static struct type *
6764 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, char *name, int refok,
6765 int noerr, int *dispp)
6772 if (refok && type != NULL)
6775 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6776 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
6777 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
6779 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
6783 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6784 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
6790 target_terminal_ours ();
6791 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6793 error (_("Type (null) is not a structure or union type"));
6796 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6797 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6798 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6799 error (_(" is not a structure or union type"));
6804 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
6806 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6808 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6812 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6815 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6818 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6819 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6822 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6825 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
6830 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6835 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6838 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
6841 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
6843 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
6844 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
6845 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
6846 if the compiler changes this practice. */
6847 const char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
6849 if (v_field_name != NULL
6850 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
6851 t = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6853 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type,
6860 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6871 target_terminal_ours ();
6872 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6875 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6876 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6877 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6878 error (_(" has no component named <null>"));
6882 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6883 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6884 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6885 error (_(" has no component named %s"), name);
6892 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6893 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
6894 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
6895 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
6898 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6900 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6902 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1, NULL)
6907 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6908 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at
6909 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
6910 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
6913 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type,
6914 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr)
6918 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6919 struct value *outer;
6920 struct value *discrim;
6921 LONGEST discrim_val;
6923 outer = value_from_contents_and_address (outer_type, outer_valaddr, 0);
6924 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
6925 if (discrim == NULL)
6927 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
6930 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
6932 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
6934 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
6938 return others_clause;
6943 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
6945 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
6946 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
6947 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
6948 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
6949 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
6951 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
6952 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
6953 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
6954 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
6955 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
6956 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
6957 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
6958 rather than struct value*s.
6960 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
6961 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
6962 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
6963 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
6964 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
6965 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
6966 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
6967 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
6968 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
6969 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
6970 element selected. */
6972 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
6973 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
6974 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
6975 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
6976 target at the target address. */
6978 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
6979 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
6980 dynamic-sized types. */
6983 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
6985 struct value *val = value_ind (val0);
6987 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6990 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
6991 qualifiers on VAL0. */
6993 static struct value *
6994 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
6996 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6998 struct value *val = val0;
7000 val = coerce_ref (val);
7001 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7007 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of
7008 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */
7011 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment)
7013 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1);
7016 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
7019 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
7021 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7025 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
7026 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
7027 require any alignment. */
7031 len = strlen (name);
7033 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
7036 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
7037 align_offset = len - 2;
7039 align_offset = len - 1;
7041 if (align_offset < 7 || strncmp ("___XV", name + align_offset - 6, 5) != 0)
7042 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7044 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7047 /* Find a typedef or tag symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
7049 static struct symbol *
7050 ada_find_any_type_symbol (const char *name)
7054 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
7055 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
7058 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
7062 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
7063 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
7066 static struct type *
7067 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
7069 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7072 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
7077 /* Given NAME_SYM and an associated BLOCK, find a "renaming" symbol
7078 associated with NAME_SYM's name. NAME_SYM may itself be a renaming
7079 symbol, in which case it is returned. Otherwise, this looks for
7080 symbols whose name is that of NAME_SYM suffixed with "___XR".
7081 Return symbol if found, and NULL otherwise. */
7084 ada_find_renaming_symbol (struct symbol *name_sym, struct block *block)
7086 const char *name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (name_sym);
7089 if (strstr (name, "___XR") != NULL)
7092 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block);
7097 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */
7098 sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7099 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL)
7105 static struct symbol *
7106 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
7108 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_linkage_function (block);
7111 if (function_sym != NULL)
7113 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully
7114 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name
7115 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of
7116 the associated renaming symbol. */
7117 const char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym);
7118 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used
7119 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building
7120 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is
7121 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function
7122 name length below. */
7123 int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name);
7124 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */
7125 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ;
7127 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */
7128 ada_remove_trailing_digits (function_name, &function_name_len);
7129 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
7130 ada_remove_Xbn_suffix (function_name, &function_name_len);
7132 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds
7133 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace
7134 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not
7135 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */
7136 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */
7137 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name)
7140 function_name_len -= 5;
7143 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
7144 strncpy (rename, function_name, function_name_len);
7145 xsnprintf (rename + function_name_len, rename_len - function_name_len,
7150 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6;
7152 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
7153 xsnprintf (rename, rename_len * sizeof (char), "%s___XR", name);
7156 return ada_find_any_type_symbol (rename);
7159 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
7160 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
7161 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
7162 otherwise return 0. */
7165 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
7169 else if (type0 == NULL)
7171 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7173 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7175 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
7177 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
7179 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
7180 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
7184 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0);
7185 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1);
7187 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
7188 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
7194 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is
7195 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */
7198 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
7202 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL)
7203 return TYPE_NAME (type);
7205 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
7208 /* Search the list of "descriptive" types associated to TYPE for a type
7209 whose name is NAME. */
7211 static struct type *
7212 find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (struct type *type, const char *name)
7214 struct type *result;
7216 /* If there no descriptive-type info, then there is no parallel type
7218 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7221 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (type);
7222 while (result != NULL)
7224 const char *result_name = ada_type_name (result);
7226 if (result_name == NULL)
7228 warning (_("unexpected null name on descriptive type"));
7232 /* If the names match, stop. */
7233 if (strcmp (result_name, name) == 0)
7236 /* Otherwise, look at the next item on the list, if any. */
7237 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7238 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7243 /* If we didn't find a match, see whether this is a packed array. With
7244 older compilers, the descriptive type information is either absent or
7245 irrelevant when it comes to packed arrays so the above lookup fails.
7246 Fall back to using a parallel lookup by name in this case. */
7247 if (result == NULL && ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
7248 return ada_find_any_type (name);
7253 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE with the specified NAME, using the
7254 descriptive type taken from the debugging information, if available,
7255 and otherwise using the (slower) name-based method. */
7257 static struct type *
7258 ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *type, const char *name)
7260 struct type *result = NULL;
7262 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7263 result = find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (type, name);
7265 result = ada_find_any_type (name);
7270 /* Same as above, but specify the name of the parallel type by appending
7271 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
7274 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
7277 const char *typename = ada_type_name (type);
7280 if (typename == NULL)
7283 len = strlen (typename);
7285 name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
7287 strcpy (name, typename);
7288 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
7290 return ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
7293 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
7294 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
7296 static struct type *
7297 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
7299 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7301 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7302 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
7306 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
7308 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
7311 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
7315 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
7316 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
7319 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
7321 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
7324 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7325 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
7328 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
7329 represent a variant record type. */
7332 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
7336 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7339 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
7341 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
7347 /* A record type with no fields. */
7349 static struct type *
7350 empty_record (struct type *template)
7352 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (template);
7354 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7355 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
7356 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
7357 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7358 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
7359 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7360 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7364 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7365 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
7366 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
7367 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
7368 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
7369 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
7370 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
7373 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
7374 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
7375 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
7377 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
7378 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
7382 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
7383 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7384 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
7385 int keep_dynamic_fields)
7387 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7390 int nfields, bit_len;
7396 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
7397 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
7398 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
7399 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
7400 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7404 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
7405 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
7406 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
7410 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
7411 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7412 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7413 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7414 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
7415 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7416 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7417 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7418 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7419 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7425 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7427 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f))
7428 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
7429 SET_FIELD_BITPOS (TYPE_FIELD (rtype, f), off);
7430 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
7432 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
7437 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
7439 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
7440 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
7441 struct type *field_type =
7442 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
7446 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
7447 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
7448 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
7449 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
7450 size first before creating the value. */
7452 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
7457 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
7458 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
7459 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
7460 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
7461 that follow this one. */
7462 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
7464 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
7466 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
7467 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
7468 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
7471 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
7472 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7473 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
7474 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7476 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
7477 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
7478 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
7479 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
7480 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
7481 would end up in an infinite loop. */
7482 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
7483 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
7484 field_address, dval, 0);
7485 /* If the field size is already larger than the maximum
7486 object size, then the record itself will necessarily
7487 be larger than the maximum object size. We need to make
7488 this check now, because the size might be so ridiculously
7489 large (due to an uninitialized variable in the inferior)
7490 that it would cause an overflow when adding it to the
7492 check_size (field_type);
7494 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
7495 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7496 /* The multiplication can potentially overflow. But because
7497 the field length has been size-checked just above, and
7498 assuming that the maximum size is a reasonable value,
7499 an overflow should not happen in practice. So rather than
7500 adding overflow recovery code to this already complex code,
7501 we just assume that it's not going to happen. */
7503 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7507 /* Note: If this field's type is a typedef, it is important
7508 to preserve the typedef layer.
7510 Otherwise, we might be transforming a typedef to a fat
7511 pointer (encoding a pointer to an unconstrained array),
7512 into a basic fat pointer (encoding an unconstrained
7513 array). As both types are implemented using the same
7514 structure, the typedef is the only clue which allows us
7515 to distinguish between the two options. Stripping it
7516 would prevent us from printing this field appropriately. */
7517 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
7518 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7519 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
7521 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
7524 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
7526 /* We need to be careful of typedefs when computing
7527 the length of our field. If this is a typedef,
7528 get the length of the target type, not the length
7530 if (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
7531 field_type = ada_typedef_target_type (field_type);
7534 TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (field_type)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7537 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
7538 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
7540 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
7541 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7544 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
7545 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
7546 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
7548 if (variant_field >= 0)
7550 struct type *branch_type;
7552 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
7555 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
7560 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7561 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7562 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7563 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7564 if (branch_type == NULL)
7566 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
7567 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7568 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7572 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7573 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7575 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
7577 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
7578 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
7579 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
7580 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7584 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
7585 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
7586 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
7587 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
7588 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
7589 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
7590 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
7592 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
7593 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."),
7594 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7596 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."),
7597 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7601 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
7602 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7605 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7606 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
7607 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7611 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
7614 static struct type *
7615 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7616 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7618 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
7622 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
7623 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
7624 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
7625 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
7626 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
7627 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
7628 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
7631 static struct type *
7632 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7638 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
7639 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
7641 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
7644 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7646 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f));
7647 struct type *new_type;
7649 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
7650 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
7652 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
7653 if (type == type0 && new_type != field_type)
7655 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
7656 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
7657 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7658 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
7659 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
7660 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7661 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
7662 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7663 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
7664 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7665 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
7666 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7668 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
7669 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
7674 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
7675 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
7676 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
7677 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
7678 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
7679 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
7681 static struct type *
7682 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7683 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7685 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7688 struct type *branch_type;
7689 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7690 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
7692 if (variant_field == -1)
7696 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
7700 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
7701 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7702 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7703 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7704 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
7705 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7706 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
7707 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7708 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7709 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7710 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
7711 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
7713 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7714 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7715 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
7716 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7718 cond_offset_target (address,
7719 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7720 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7721 if (branch_type == NULL)
7725 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
7726 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7727 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7731 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7732 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7733 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
7734 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
7736 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
7738 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7742 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7743 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
7744 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
7745 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
7746 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
7747 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
7748 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
7749 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
7750 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
7752 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
7753 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
7754 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
7755 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
7756 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
7757 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
7758 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
7760 static struct type *
7761 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7762 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7764 struct type *templ_type;
7766 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7769 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7771 if (templ_type != NULL)
7772 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
7773 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
7775 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
7777 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
7782 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
7788 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7789 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
7790 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
7791 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
7792 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
7793 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
7794 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
7796 static struct type *
7797 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7798 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7801 struct type *templ_type;
7802 struct type *var_type;
7804 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7805 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
7807 var_type = var_type0;
7809 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
7811 if (templ_type != NULL)
7812 var_type = templ_type;
7814 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
7817 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type,
7818 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval));
7821 return empty_record (var_type);
7822 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
7823 return to_fixed_record_type
7824 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
7825 valaddr, address, dval);
7826 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
7828 to_fixed_record_type
7829 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
7831 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
7834 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
7835 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
7836 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
7837 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
7838 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
7839 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
7842 static struct type *
7843 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
7846 struct type *index_type_desc;
7847 struct type *result;
7848 int constrained_packed_array_p;
7850 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
7851 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
7854 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
7855 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
7856 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
7858 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XA");
7859 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
7860 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
7862 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
7864 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7865 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7867 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7868 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7869 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7870 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7871 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7872 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7873 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7874 consult the object tag. */
7875 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
7877 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
7878 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
7879 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
7880 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
7883 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
7884 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
7889 struct type *elt_type0;
7892 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
7893 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7895 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7896 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7898 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7899 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7900 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7901 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7902 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7903 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7904 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7905 consult the object tag. */
7907 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
7910 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
7912 struct type *range_type =
7913 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, i), dval);
7915 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
7916 result, range_type);
7917 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7919 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
7920 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7923 /* We want to preserve the type name. This can be useful when
7924 trying to get the type name of a value that has already been
7925 printed (for instance, if the user did "print VAR; whatis $". */
7926 TYPE_NAME (result) = TYPE_NAME (type0);
7928 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
7930 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
7931 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
7932 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
7933 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
7934 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
7935 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
7937 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
7938 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
7939 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
7940 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
7943 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
7948 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
7949 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
7950 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
7951 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
7952 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
7954 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
7955 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
7956 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
7957 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
7958 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
7960 static struct type *
7961 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7962 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7964 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7965 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
7969 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7971 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7972 struct type *fixed_record_type =
7973 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7975 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
7976 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
7977 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
7978 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
7979 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
7982 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
7984 struct type *real_type =
7985 type_from_tag (value_tag_from_contents_and_address
7990 if (real_type != NULL)
7991 return to_fixed_record_type (real_type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7994 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
7995 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
7996 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
7998 const char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
7999 char *xvz_name = alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
8003 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
8004 size = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, &xvz_found);
8005 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
8007 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
8008 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
8010 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
8011 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
8012 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
8014 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
8015 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
8016 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
8017 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
8020 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
8021 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
8022 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
8023 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
8024 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
8025 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
8026 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
8027 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
8028 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
8029 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
8030 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
8033 return fixed_record_type;
8035 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8036 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
8037 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8041 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
8045 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
8046 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
8048 The typedef layer needs be preserved in order to differentiate between
8049 arrays and array pointers when both types are implemented using the same
8050 fat pointer. In the array pointer case, the pointer is encoded as
8051 a typedef of the pointer type. For instance, considering:
8053 type String_Access is access String;
8054 S1 : String_Access := null;
8056 To the debugger, S1 is defined as a typedef of type String. But
8057 to the user, it is a pointer. So if the user tries to print S1,
8058 we should not dereference the array, but print the array address
8061 If we didn't preserve the typedef layer, we would lose the fact that
8062 the type is to be presented as a pointer (needs de-reference before
8063 being printed). And we would also use the source-level type name. */
8066 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8067 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8070 struct type *fixed_type =
8071 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
8073 /* If TYPE is a typedef and its target type is the same as the FIXED_TYPE,
8074 then preserve the typedef layer.
8076 Implementation note: We can only check the main-type portion of
8077 the TYPE and FIXED_TYPE, because eliminating the typedef layer
8078 from TYPE now returns a type that has the same instance flags
8079 as TYPE. For instance, if TYPE is a "typedef const", and its
8080 target type is a "struct", then the typedef elimination will return
8081 a "const" version of the target type. See check_typedef for more
8082 details about how the typedef layer elimination is done.
8084 brobecker/2010-11-19: It seems to me that the only case where it is
8085 useful to preserve the typedef layer is when dealing with fat pointers.
8086 Perhaps, we could add a check for that and preserve the typedef layer
8087 only in that situation. But this seems unecessary so far, probably
8088 because we call check_typedef/ada_check_typedef pretty much everywhere.
8090 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8091 && (TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (ada_typedef_target_type (type))
8092 == TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (fixed_type)))
8098 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
8099 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
8101 static struct type *
8102 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8109 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8112 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8114 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
8118 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8119 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8121 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8123 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8124 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8125 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
8127 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8129 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8133 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
8135 static struct type *
8136 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
8138 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8140 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
8141 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
8142 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
8144 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
8148 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
8150 if (raw_real_type == type)
8153 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
8157 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
8158 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
8160 type FooP is access Foo;
8162 type Foo is array ...;
8163 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
8164 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
8165 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
8166 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
8168 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
8169 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
8172 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
8177 /* If our type is a typedef type of a fat pointer, then we're done.
8178 We don't want to strip the TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF layer, because this is
8179 what allows us to distinguish between fat pointers that represent
8180 array types, and fat pointers that represent array access types
8181 (in both cases, the compiler implements them as fat pointers). */
8182 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8183 && is_thick_pntr (ada_typedef_target_type (type)))
8186 CHECK_TYPEDEF (type);
8187 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
8188 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
8189 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL)
8193 const char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
8194 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
8199 /* TYPE1 might itself be a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF (this can happen with
8200 stubs pointing to arrays, as we don't create symbols for array
8201 types, only for the typedef-to-array types). If that's the case,
8202 strip the typedef layer. */
8203 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
8204 type1 = ada_check_typedef (type1);
8210 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
8211 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
8212 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
8213 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
8214 creation of struct values]. */
8216 static struct value *
8217 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
8220 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
8222 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
8225 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
8228 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
8229 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
8233 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
8235 val = unwrap_value (val);
8236 val = ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val),
8237 value_address (val),
8245 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
8246 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
8248 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
8266 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
8268 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
8269 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
8271 return attribute_names[0];
8274 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
8277 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
8279 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
8280 struct type *type = value_type (val);
8282 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
8283 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
8285 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
8288 LONGEST v = value_as_long (val);
8290 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
8292 if (v == TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, i))
8295 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
8298 return value_as_long (val);
8301 static struct value *
8302 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8304 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
8307 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
8309 static struct value *
8310 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8312 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
8313 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
8314 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
8315 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
8317 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
8319 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
8321 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
8322 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
8323 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, pos));
8326 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
8332 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
8333 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
8334 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
8337 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
8341 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
8342 and don't check any further. */
8343 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
8346 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
8347 with a known character type name. */
8348 name = ada_type_name (type);
8349 return (name != NULL
8350 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
8351 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
8352 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
8353 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
8354 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
8355 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
8358 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
8361 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
8363 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8365 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
8366 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
8367 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
8368 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
8370 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
8372 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
8378 /* The compiler sometimes provides a parallel XVS type for a given
8379 PAD type. Normally, it is safe to follow the PAD type directly,
8380 but older versions of the compiler have a bug that causes the offset
8381 of its "F" field to be wrong. Following that field in that case
8382 would lead to incorrect results, but this can be worked around
8383 by ignoring the PAD type and using the associated XVS type instead.
8385 Set to True if the debugger should trust the contents of PAD types.
8386 Otherwise, ignore the PAD type if there is a parallel XVS type. */
8387 static int trust_pad_over_xvs = 1;
8389 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
8390 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
8391 distinctive name. */
8394 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
8396 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8398 if (!trust_pad_over_xvs && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
8401 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8402 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
8403 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
8406 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
8407 the parallel type. */
8410 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
8412 struct type *real_type_namer;
8413 struct type *raw_real_type;
8415 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8418 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
8419 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
8420 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
8423 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
8424 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
8425 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
8426 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
8427 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
8428 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
8429 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
8430 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
8433 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
8434 if (real_type_namer == NULL
8435 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8436 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
8439 if (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
8441 /* This is an older encoding form where the base type needs to be
8442 looked up by name. We prefer the newer enconding because it is
8444 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
8445 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
8448 return raw_real_type;
8451 /* The field in our XVS type is a reference to the base type. */
8452 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0));
8455 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
8458 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
8460 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8461 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
8463 return ada_get_base_type (type);
8467 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
8468 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
8471 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
8473 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8474 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
8476 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
8477 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8484 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
8485 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
8487 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
8489 static char *result;
8490 static size_t result_len = 0;
8493 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
8494 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
8495 all the preceding characters, the unqualified name starts
8496 right after that dot.
8497 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
8498 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
8499 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
8500 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
8502 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
8507 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
8509 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
8520 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
8522 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
8528 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
8529 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
8530 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
8531 else if (name[1] == 'U')
8532 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
8534 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
8540 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
8542 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
8545 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
8546 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
8547 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
8555 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
8556 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
8559 static struct value *
8560 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8562 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
8565 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
8568 static struct value *
8569 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
8571 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
8573 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8575 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
8576 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
8578 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
8579 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
8581 return unwrap_value (v);
8585 struct type *raw_real_type =
8586 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
8588 /* If there is no parallel XVS or XVE type, then the value is
8589 already unwrapped. Return it without further modification. */
8590 if ((type == raw_real_type)
8591 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE") == NULL)
8595 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
8596 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
8597 value_address (val),
8602 static struct value *
8603 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8607 if (type == value_type (arg))
8609 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
8610 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type,
8611 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
8612 value_as_long (arg)));
8615 DOUBLEST argd = value_as_double (arg);
8617 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd);
8620 return value_from_longest (type, val);
8623 static struct value *
8624 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
8626 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
8627 value_as_long (arg));
8629 return value_from_double (type, val);
8632 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
8633 return the converted value. */
8635 static struct value *
8636 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
8638 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
8643 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
8644 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8646 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
8647 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8649 val = ada_value_ind (val);
8650 type2 = value_type (val);
8653 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8654 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8656 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type2) != TYPE_LENGTH (type)
8657 || TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
8658 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)))
8659 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
8660 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
8665 static struct value *
8666 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
8669 struct type *type1, *type2;
8672 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
8673 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
8674 type1 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
8675 type2 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
8677 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
8678 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
8679 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8688 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8691 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
8693 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
8695 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
8696 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8698 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
8703 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
8704 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
8712 /* Should not reach this point. */
8716 val = allocate_value (type1);
8717 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
8718 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
8719 gdbarch_byte_order (get_type_arch (type1)), v);
8724 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
8726 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
8727 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
8729 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
8730 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
8731 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
8732 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
8734 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
8735 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
8736 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8737 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8738 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
8739 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
8740 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
8741 and do not have user-defined equality. */
8743 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2))
8744 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
8745 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0;
8747 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8750 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
8751 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
8755 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
8759 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8762 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
8764 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
8770 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8773 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
8778 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
8779 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
8780 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
8781 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
8782 LHS == CONTAINER). */
8785 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
8786 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8788 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8791 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8793 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
8794 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
8796 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
8800 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
8801 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (elt);
8804 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8805 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8807 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
8808 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8811 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8814 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
8815 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
8816 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
8817 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
8818 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
8819 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
8820 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
8822 static struct value *
8823 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
8824 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8825 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8827 struct type *lhs_type;
8828 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
8829 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
8832 int max_indices, num_indices;
8833 int is_array_aggregate;
8837 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
8839 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8840 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
8844 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
8845 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
8846 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
8847 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
8848 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
8849 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
8851 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8852 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
8854 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
8855 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8856 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8857 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8858 is_array_aggregate = 1;
8860 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8863 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
8864 is_array_aggregate = 0;
8867 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
8869 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
8870 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
8871 indices = alloca (max_indices * sizeof (indices[0]));
8872 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
8873 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
8876 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8878 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
8881 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8882 &num_indices, max_indices,
8883 low_index, high_index);
8886 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8887 &num_indices, max_indices,
8888 low_index, high_index);
8892 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
8893 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8894 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
8897 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
8904 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
8905 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8906 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
8907 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
8908 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
8909 assign_aggregate. */
8911 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
8912 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8913 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8914 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8916 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
8918 if (ind - 1 == high)
8919 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
8922 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
8924 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
8927 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8930 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
8931 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8932 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
8933 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
8934 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
8936 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
8937 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8938 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8939 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8942 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
8943 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
8944 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
8946 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
8948 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8949 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8951 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8953 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8955 LONGEST lower, upper;
8956 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
8958 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
8961 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8963 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8968 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
8980 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
8983 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol);
8986 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
8988 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8990 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
8991 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
8992 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
8993 lower = upper = ind;
8996 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
8997 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
8999 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
9001 while (lower <= upper)
9006 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
9012 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
9013 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
9014 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
9015 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
9016 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9018 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
9019 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9020 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
9021 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9024 int expr_pc = *pos + 1;
9026 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
9030 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
9035 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &localpos);
9038 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9041 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
9042 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
9043 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
9044 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
9046 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
9047 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
9051 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
9052 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
9056 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
9057 if (high < indices[kh])
9059 if (low < indices[i])
9061 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
9062 if (high > indices[i + 1])
9063 indices[i + 1] = high;
9064 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
9065 *size -= kh - i - 2;
9068 else if (high < indices[i])
9072 if (*size == max_size)
9073 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
9075 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
9076 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
9078 indices[i + 1] = high;
9081 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
9084 static struct value *
9085 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside)
9087 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
9090 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
9091 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2));
9093 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9094 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
9096 return value_cast (type, arg2);
9099 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
9100 ------------------------------------------------------
9105 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
9106 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
9107 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
9108 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
9109 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
9110 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
9113 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
9114 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
9115 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
9116 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
9117 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
9119 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
9120 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
9121 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
9122 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
9123 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
9124 in the GNAT sources.
9126 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
9127 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
9128 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
9129 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
9130 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
9131 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
9133 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
9134 -----------------------------------------
9136 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
9137 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
9138 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
9140 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
9143 when False => Value : Integer;
9146 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
9147 No : Rec := (empty => True);
9149 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
9150 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
9151 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
9152 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
9153 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
9154 We also informally refer to this opperation as "fixing" an object,
9155 which means creating its associated fixed type.
9157 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
9158 type would look like this:
9165 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
9172 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
9173 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
9174 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
9175 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
9177 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
9178 ---------------------
9180 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
9181 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
9182 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
9183 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
9184 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
9185 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
9186 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
9187 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
9188 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
9189 when (if) necessary.
9191 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
9192 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
9193 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
9194 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
9196 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
9198 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
9199 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
9200 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
9201 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
9202 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
9203 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
9204 the size of each element).
9206 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
9207 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
9209 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
9211 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
9213 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
9215 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
9216 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
9217 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
9219 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
9220 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
9221 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
9222 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
9223 these wrapper types.
9225 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
9226 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
9227 and the array element should remain unfixed.
9229 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
9230 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
9232 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
9233 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
9236 when True => Length : Integer;
9240 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
9242 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
9243 Data => (others => 17),
9247 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
9248 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
9249 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
9250 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
9251 be used for the fixed array.
9253 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
9254 ----------------------------------
9256 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
9257 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
9258 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
9259 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
9260 type of each of these components.
9262 Consider for instance the example:
9264 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
9265 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
9268 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
9270 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
9271 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
9272 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
9273 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
9274 record requires us to fix each of its components.
9276 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
9277 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
9278 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
9279 (assuming type Rec above):
9281 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
9285 when True => Another : Integer;
9289 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
9290 First => (Empty => True),
9293 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
9294 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
9295 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
9298 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
9299 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
9300 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
9301 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
9302 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
9303 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
9304 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
9305 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
9306 compute the wrong offset of field After.
9308 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
9309 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
9310 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
9311 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
9312 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
9313 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
9314 observed with the following type declarations:
9316 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
9317 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
9318 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
9320 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
9321 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
9325 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
9326 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
9328 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
9329 ----------------------------------------------------------
9331 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
9332 thus far, be actually fixed?
9334 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
9335 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
9336 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
9337 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
9338 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
9339 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
9340 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
9341 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
9343 Note that one of the side-effects of miscomputing the offset and
9344 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
9345 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
9346 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
9347 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
9348 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
9349 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
9350 entiry. Results in this case as unpredicatble, as we usually read
9351 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
9353 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
9354 for the Ada language. */
9356 static struct value *
9357 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
9358 int *pos, enum noside noside)
9363 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
9366 struct value **argvec;
9370 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
9376 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9377 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
9379 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
9380 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
9381 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
9382 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
9383 types in Ada have different representations.
9385 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
9387 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
9388 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside);
9394 struct value *result;
9397 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9398 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
9399 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
9400 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
9401 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
9407 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
9408 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9409 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9411 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside);
9416 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
9417 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9420 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9421 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
9423 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
9424 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9426 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
9428 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
9429 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
9430 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
9431 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
9432 type = value_type (arg1);
9433 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
9435 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
9436 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9438 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9439 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
9440 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9442 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
9444 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
9445 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
9448 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9449 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9450 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9452 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9453 return (value_from_longest
9455 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
9456 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
9457 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9458 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
9459 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
9460 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
9461 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
9462 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
9463 type = value_type (arg1);
9464 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9465 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9466 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9467 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
9470 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9471 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
9472 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9474 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9475 return (value_from_longest
9477 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
9478 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
9479 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9480 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
9481 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction "
9482 "must have the same type"));
9483 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
9484 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
9485 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
9486 type = value_type (arg1);
9487 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
9488 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9489 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9490 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
9496 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9497 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9498 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9500 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9502 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9503 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9507 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
9508 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9509 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
9510 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
9511 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
9512 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9513 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9517 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9518 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9519 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
9520 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9522 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9526 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9527 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
9529 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
9531 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9532 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
9535 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9536 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9538 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
9539 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
9542 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
9543 return value_neg (arg1);
9546 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9547 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9548 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9553 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9554 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9555 return value_cast (type, val);
9558 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9559 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9560 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9564 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
9566 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9568 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
9574 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9579 else if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
9580 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
9581 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
9583 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
9584 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
9585 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9587 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
9588 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
9589 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
9590 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
9591 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
9592 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
9593 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0)
9594 || (TYPE_CODE(type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9595 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0)))
9597 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
9598 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
9599 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
9600 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
9603 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
9604 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
9605 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
9606 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
9607 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
9608 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
9609 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
9610 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
9611 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
9612 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
9613 type in the type description. */
9614 struct type *actual_type;
9616 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
9617 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
9618 if (actual_type == NULL)
9619 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
9620 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
9621 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
9622 This can happen if the debugging information is
9623 incomplete, for instance. */
9626 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
9631 (to_static_fixed_type
9632 (static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))),
9637 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9638 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
9644 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
9645 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
9646 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9648 (struct value **) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 2));
9650 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
9651 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
9652 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
9653 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
9656 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
9657 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9660 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9664 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
9665 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
9666 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
9667 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9668 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
9669 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
9670 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
9673 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9674 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9675 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory))
9676 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
9678 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
9680 /* Ada allows us to implicitly dereference arrays when subscripting
9681 them. So, if this is an array typedef (encoding use for array
9682 access types encoded as fat pointers), strip it now. */
9683 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
9684 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
9686 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9688 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
9690 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
9691 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9693 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
9695 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
9696 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9697 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
9698 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9701 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
9702 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
9707 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
9709 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
9710 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9712 struct type *rtype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9714 if (TYPE_GNU_IFUNC (type))
9715 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (rtype));
9716 return allocate_value (rtype);
9718 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
9719 case TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION:
9720 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9721 /* We don't know anything about what the internal
9722 function might return, but we have to return
9724 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
9727 return call_internal_function (exp->gdbarch, exp->language_defn,
9728 argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
9730 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
9734 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
9735 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9737 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
9739 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
9740 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9741 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9743 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
9744 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
9746 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
9747 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9749 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9751 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
9753 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9756 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
9757 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
9758 nargs, argvec + 1));
9759 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
9760 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
9761 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9763 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
9765 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
9767 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9770 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0], type,
9771 nargs, argvec + 1));
9774 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
9775 "array or function"));
9780 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9781 struct value *low_bound_val =
9782 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9783 struct value *high_bound_val =
9784 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9788 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
9789 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
9790 low_bound = pos_atr (low_bound_val);
9791 high_bound = pos_atr (high_bound_val);
9793 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9796 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
9798 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9799 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
9800 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
9801 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
9803 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
9804 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
9806 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
9807 convert to a pointer. */
9808 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9809 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9810 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
9811 array = value_addr (array);
9813 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
9814 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
9815 (value_type (array))))
9816 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound);
9818 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
9820 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
9821 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
9822 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9823 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
9825 array = value_ind (array);
9827 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
9828 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
9829 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
9830 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
9831 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
9832 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
9834 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (array)))
9837 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
9839 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9840 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), low_bound);
9843 struct type *arr_type0 =
9844 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), NULL, 1);
9846 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
9847 longest_to_int (low_bound),
9848 longest_to_int (high_bound));
9851 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9853 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
9854 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound);
9856 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
9857 longest_to_int (high_bound));
9862 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9863 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
9865 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9868 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
9871 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
9872 "always returns true"));
9873 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9874 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
9876 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
9877 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
9878 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
9879 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9880 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9881 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9883 value_from_longest (type,
9884 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9885 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9886 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9887 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9890 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
9892 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9893 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9895 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9898 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9900 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9901 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9904 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9906 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
9908 type = value_type (arg1);
9910 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
9911 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
9913 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9914 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9915 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9917 value_from_longest (type,
9918 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9919 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9920 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9921 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9923 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
9924 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9925 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9926 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9928 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9931 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
9932 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
9933 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
9935 value_from_longest (type,
9936 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
9937 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
9938 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
9939 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
9945 struct type *type_arg;
9947 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
9949 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9951 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
9955 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9959 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
9960 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
9961 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
9964 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9967 if (type_arg == NULL)
9969 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9971 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
9972 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9974 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
9975 ada_attribute_name (op));
9977 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9979 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9980 return allocate_value (type);
9984 default: /* Should never happen. */
9985 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9987 return value_from_longest
9988 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
9990 return value_from_longest
9991 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
9993 return value_from_longest
9994 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
9997 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
9999 struct type *range_type;
10000 const char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
10003 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
10004 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (type_arg, NULL);
10005 if (range_type == NULL)
10006 range_type = type_arg;
10010 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10012 return value_from_longest
10013 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
10015 return value_from_longest
10016 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
10017 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10018 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
10021 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
10022 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
10027 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
10028 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
10030 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
10032 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10034 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10035 return allocate_value (type);
10040 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10042 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
10043 return value_from_longest (type, low);
10045 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
10046 return value_from_longest (type, high);
10047 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10048 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
10049 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
10050 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
10056 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10057 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10060 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10061 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
10063 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
10067 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10068 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10069 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10070 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10072 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10073 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10076 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10077 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
10078 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
10081 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
10083 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
10085 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10086 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10089 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
10090 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
10092 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
10093 ada_modulus (type_arg));
10098 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10099 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10100 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10102 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10103 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10104 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10106 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
10109 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10110 type = value_type (arg1);
10112 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
10113 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
10114 not the size of the pointer. */
10115 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10116 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10118 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10120 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10121 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
10123 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10124 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
10127 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10128 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10129 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
10130 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10132 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10133 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10135 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
10138 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10139 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10140 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10142 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10143 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10146 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
10147 only promote the first argument. */
10148 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
10149 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10151 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10153 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
10157 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10158 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10164 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10165 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10167 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10168 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
10169 return value_neg (arg1);
10174 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10175 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10177 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
10178 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10180 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
10181 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
10183 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
10185 if (arrType == NULL)
10186 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
10187 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
10189 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
10190 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10191 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
10192 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
10194 type = to_static_fixed_type
10196 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
10198 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
10200 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
10202 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
10203 if (expect_type == NULL)
10204 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10209 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
10210 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
10214 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
10216 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
10217 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
10219 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
10220 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
10221 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
10222 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
10224 if (expect_type != NULL)
10225 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
10228 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10229 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
10232 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
10233 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
10234 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
10236 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
10238 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
10239 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10240 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
10241 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10242 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10244 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10246 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
10248 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
10250 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
10251 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
10254 /* In this case, we assume that the field COULD exist
10255 in some extension of the type. Return an object of
10256 "type" void, which will match any formal
10257 (see ada_type_match). */
10258 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_void,
10263 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
10266 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10269 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
10270 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
10271 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
10274 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
10275 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
10277 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10279 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10280 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
10282 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
10287 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
10288 case OP_POSITIONAL:
10290 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
10294 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
10295 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
10297 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
10299 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10300 _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
10303 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
10305 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
10306 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
10311 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, 1);
10317 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
10318 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
10319 Otherwise, return NULL. */
10321 static const char *
10322 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
10324 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
10325 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
10327 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
10329 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
10336 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
10337 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10342 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
10345 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
10347 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
10350 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
10353 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
10355 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
10356 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
10359 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
10360 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the
10361 delta cannot be determined. */
10364 ada_delta (struct type *type)
10366 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
10369 /* Strictly speaking, num and den are encoded as integer. However,
10370 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
10371 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
10372 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
10379 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
10380 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
10383 scaling_factor (struct type *type)
10385 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
10386 DOUBLEST num0, den0, num1, den1;
10389 /* Strictly speaking, num's and den's are encoded as integer. However,
10390 they may not fit into a long, and they will have to be converted
10391 to DOUBLEST anyway. So scan them as DOUBLEST. */
10392 n = sscanf (encoding,
10393 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT
10394 "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT "_%" DOUBLEST_SCAN_FORMAT,
10395 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
10400 return num1 / den1;
10402 return num0 / den0;
10406 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point
10407 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */
10410 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x)
10412 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type);
10415 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE
10416 corresponding to the value X. */
10419 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x)
10421 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5);
10428 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
10429 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
10430 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
10431 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
10432 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
10435 scan_discrim_bound (char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
10438 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
10439 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
10442 struct value *bound_val;
10444 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
10447 pend = strstr (str + k, "__");
10451 k += strlen (bound);
10455 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, pend - (str + k) + 1);
10456 bound = bound_buffer;
10457 strncpy (bound_buffer, str + k, pend - (str + k));
10458 bound[pend - (str + k)] = '\0';
10462 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
10463 if (bound_val == NULL)
10466 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
10467 if (pnew_k != NULL)
10472 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
10473 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
10474 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
10476 static struct value *
10477 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg)
10479 struct ada_symbol_info *syms;
10482 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN,
10487 if (err_msg == NULL)
10490 error (("%s"), err_msg);
10493 return value_of_variable (syms[0].sym, syms[0].block);
10496 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If
10497 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If
10498 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */
10501 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag)
10503 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
10515 return value_as_long (var_val);
10520 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
10521 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
10522 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
10523 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
10524 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
10525 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
10526 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
10527 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
10529 static struct type *
10530 to_fixed_range_type (struct type *raw_type, struct value *dval)
10533 struct type *base_type;
10534 char *subtype_info;
10536 gdb_assert (raw_type != NULL);
10537 gdb_assert (TYPE_NAME (raw_type) != NULL);
10539 if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
10540 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
10542 base_type = raw_type;
10544 name = TYPE_NAME (raw_type);
10545 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
10546 if (subtype_info == NULL)
10548 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
10549 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
10551 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
10554 return create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), raw_type,
10555 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type),
10556 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type));
10560 static char *name_buf = NULL;
10561 static size_t name_len = 0;
10562 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
10568 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
10569 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
10570 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
10573 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
10576 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
10578 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
10579 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
10581 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
10583 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
10591 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
10592 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
10595 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
10600 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
10602 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
10603 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
10610 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
10611 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
10614 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
10619 type = create_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), base_type, L, U);
10620 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
10625 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
10628 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
10630 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
10634 /* Modular types */
10636 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
10639 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
10641 struct type *subranged_type = get_base_type (type);
10643 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
10644 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
10645 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
10648 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
10651 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
10653 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
10657 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
10658 ---------------------------------
10660 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
10661 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
10662 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
10663 . catchpoints on failed assertions
10665 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
10666 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
10667 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
10668 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
10669 to zero-in on certain situations.
10671 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
10672 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
10673 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
10674 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
10677 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
10678 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
10679 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
10680 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
10681 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged. */
10683 /* The different types of catchpoints that we introduced for catching
10686 enum exception_catchpoint_kind
10688 ex_catch_exception,
10689 ex_catch_exception_unhandled,
10693 /* Ada's standard exceptions. */
10695 static char *standard_exc[] = {
10696 "constraint_error",
10702 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
10704 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
10705 for a given executable. */
10707 struct exception_support_info
10709 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10710 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
10711 const char *catch_exception_sym;
10713 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10714 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
10715 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
10717 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
10718 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
10719 const char *catch_assert_sym;
10721 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
10722 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
10723 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
10724 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
10725 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
10728 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
10729 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
10731 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
10732 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
10733 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */
10735 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
10737 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
10738 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
10739 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
10740 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
10743 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
10744 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
10745 of the Ada runtime. */
10747 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
10749 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
10750 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
10751 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
10752 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
10755 /* Return nonzero if we can detect the exception support routines
10756 described in EINFO.
10758 This function errors out if an abnormal situation is detected
10759 (for instance, if we find the exception support routines, but
10760 that support is found to be incomplete). */
10763 ada_has_this_exception_support (const struct exception_support_info *einfo)
10765 struct symbol *sym;
10767 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
10768 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
10769 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. */
10771 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10774 /* Perhaps we did not find our symbol because the Ada runtime was
10775 compiled without debugging info, or simply stripped of it.
10776 It happens on some GNU/Linux distributions for instance, where
10777 users have to install a separate debug package in order to get
10778 the runtime's debugging info. In that situation, let the user
10779 know why we cannot insert an Ada exception catchpoint.
10781 Note: Just for the purpose of inserting our Ada exception
10782 catchpoint, we could rely purely on the associated minimal symbol.
10783 But we would be operating in degraded mode anyway, since we are
10784 still lacking the debugging info needed later on to extract
10785 the name of the exception being raised (this name is printed in
10786 the catchpoint message, and is also used when trying to catch
10787 a specific exception). We do not handle this case for now. */
10788 if (lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, NULL))
10789 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
10790 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
10791 "in this configuration."));
10796 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
10798 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
10799 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
10800 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
10805 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
10806 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
10808 This function will always set the per-inferior exception_info,
10809 or raise an error. */
10812 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
10814 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
10816 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
10817 if (data->exception_info != NULL)
10820 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
10821 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&default_exception_support_info))
10823 data->exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
10827 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
10828 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_fallback))
10830 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
10834 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
10835 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
10836 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
10837 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
10840 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown) != language_ada)
10841 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
10843 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
10844 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
10845 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
10846 in a shared library. */
10848 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0)
10849 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
10851 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
10852 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
10853 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
10854 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
10855 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
10856 supporting this feature. */
10858 error (_("Cannot insert Ada exception catchpoints in this configuration."));
10861 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
10862 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
10863 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
10867 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
10869 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10870 const char *func_name;
10871 enum language func_lang;
10874 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
10875 This cannot be any user code. */
10877 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal);
10878 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
10881 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
10882 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
10883 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
10884 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
10885 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
10887 if (symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab) == NULL)
10890 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming.
10891 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
10892 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
10895 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
10897 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
10898 if (re_exec (sal.symtab->filename))
10900 if (sal.symtab->objfile != NULL
10901 && re_exec (sal.symtab->objfile->name))
10905 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
10907 find_frame_funname (frame, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL);
10908 if (func_name == NULL)
10911 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
10913 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
10914 if (re_exec (func_name))
10921 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
10922 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
10925 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
10927 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
10929 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
10938 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
10939 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
10940 of the exception is stored.
10942 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
10945 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
10947 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
10950 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
10951 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
10952 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
10953 several frames up in the callstack. */
10956 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
10959 struct frame_info *fi;
10960 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
10962 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
10963 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
10964 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
10965 without checking the name of their associated function. */
10966 fi = get_current_frame ();
10967 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
10969 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
10973 const char *func_name;
10974 enum language func_lang;
10976 find_frame_funname (fi, &func_name, &func_lang, NULL);
10977 if (func_name != NULL
10978 && strcmp (func_name, data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
10979 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
10980 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
10987 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
10990 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
10991 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
10992 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
10994 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
10997 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10998 struct breakpoint *b)
11000 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11004 case ex_catch_exception:
11005 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
11008 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11009 return data->exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
11012 case ex_catch_assert:
11013 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
11017 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11021 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
11024 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
11025 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
11026 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
11027 and zero is returned. */
11030 ada_exception_name_addr (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11031 struct breakpoint *b)
11033 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
11034 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
11036 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
11038 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
11043 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message);
11050 static struct symtab_and_line ada_exception_sal (enum exception_catchpoint_kind,
11052 const struct breakpoint_ops **);
11053 static char *ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string);
11055 /* Ada catchpoints.
11057 In the case of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, the catchpoint will
11058 stop the target on every exception the program throws. When a user
11059 specifies the name of a specific exception, we translate this
11060 request into a condition expression (in text form), and then parse
11061 it into an expression stored in each of the catchpoint's locations.
11062 We then use this condition to check whether the exception that was
11063 raised is the one the user is interested in. If not, then the
11064 target is resumed again. We store the name of the requested
11065 exception, in order to be able to re-set the condition expression
11066 when symbols change. */
11068 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint
11069 breakpoint location. It includes a "struct bp_location" as a kind
11070 of base class; users downcast to "struct bp_location *" when
11073 struct ada_catchpoint_location
11075 /* The base class. */
11076 struct bp_location base;
11078 /* The condition that checks whether the exception that was raised
11079 is the specific exception the user specified on catchpoint
11081 struct expression *excep_cond_expr;
11084 /* Implement the DTOR method in the bp_location_ops structure for all
11085 Ada exception catchpoint kinds. */
11088 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor (struct bp_location *bl)
11090 struct ada_catchpoint_location *al = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11092 xfree (al->excep_cond_expr);
11095 /* The vtable to be used in Ada catchpoint locations. */
11097 static const struct bp_location_ops ada_catchpoint_location_ops =
11099 ada_catchpoint_location_dtor
11102 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint.
11103 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
11104 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. */
11106 struct ada_catchpoint
11108 /* The base class. */
11109 struct breakpoint base;
11111 /* The name of the specific exception the user specified. */
11112 char *excep_string;
11115 /* Parse the exception condition string in the context of each of the
11116 catchpoint's locations, and store them for later evaluation. */
11119 create_excep_cond_exprs (struct ada_catchpoint *c)
11121 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11122 struct bp_location *bl;
11125 /* Nothing to do if there's no specific exception to catch. */
11126 if (c->excep_string == NULL)
11129 /* Same if there are no locations... */
11130 if (c->base.loc == NULL)
11133 /* Compute the condition expression in text form, from the specific
11134 expection we want to catch. */
11135 cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (c->excep_string);
11136 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
11138 /* Iterate over all the catchpoint's locations, and parse an
11139 expression for each. */
11140 for (bl = c->base.loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
11142 struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
11143 = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11144 struct expression *exp = NULL;
11146 if (!bl->shlib_disabled)
11148 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
11152 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
11154 exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl->address,
11155 block_for_pc (bl->address), 0);
11158 warning (_("failed to reevaluate internal exception condition "
11159 "for catchpoint %d: %s"),
11160 c->base.number, e.message);
11163 ada_loc->excep_cond_expr = exp;
11166 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11169 /* Implement the DTOR method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
11170 exception catchpoint kinds. */
11173 dtor_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
11175 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11177 xfree (c->excep_string);
11179 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
11182 /* Implement the ALLOCATE_LOCATION method in the breakpoint_ops
11183 structure for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11185 static struct bp_location *
11186 allocate_location_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11187 struct breakpoint *self)
11189 struct ada_catchpoint_location *loc;
11191 loc = XNEW (struct ada_catchpoint_location);
11192 init_bp_location (&loc->base, &ada_catchpoint_location_ops, self);
11193 loc->excep_cond_expr = NULL;
11197 /* Implement the RE_SET method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
11198 exception catchpoint kinds. */
11201 re_set_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
11203 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11205 /* Call the base class's method. This updates the catchpoint's
11207 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.re_set (b);
11209 /* Reparse the exception conditional expressions. One for each
11211 create_excep_cond_exprs (c);
11214 /* Returns true if we should stop for this breakpoint hit. If the
11215 user specified a specific exception, we only want to cause a stop
11216 if the program thrown that exception. */
11219 should_stop_exception (const struct bp_location *bl)
11221 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
11222 const struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
11223 = (const struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
11224 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
11227 /* With no specific exception, should always stop. */
11228 if (c->excep_string == NULL)
11231 if (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr == NULL)
11233 /* We will have a NULL expression if back when we were creating
11234 the expressions, this location's had failed to parse. */
11239 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11241 struct value *mark;
11243 mark = value_mark ();
11244 stop = value_true (evaluate_expression (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr));
11245 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11248 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
11249 _("Error in testing exception condition:\n"));
11253 /* Implement the CHECK_STATUS method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11254 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11257 check_status_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs)
11259 bs->stop = should_stop_exception (bs->bp_location_at);
11262 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11263 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11265 static enum print_stop_action
11266 print_it_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, bpstat bs)
11268 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11269 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
11271 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
11273 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11275 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
11276 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
11277 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
11280 ui_out_text (uiout,
11281 b->disposition == disp_del ? "\nTemporary catchpoint "
11282 : "\nCatchpoint ");
11283 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11284 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
11288 case ex_catch_exception:
11289 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11291 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b);
11292 char exception_name[256];
11296 read_memory (addr, exception_name, sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
11297 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
11301 /* For some reason, we were unable to read the exception
11302 name. This could happen if the Runtime was compiled
11303 without debugging info, for instance. In that case,
11304 just replace the exception name by the generic string
11305 "exception" - it will read as "an exception" in the
11306 notification we are about to print. */
11307 memcpy (exception_name, "exception", sizeof ("exception"));
11309 /* In the case of unhandled exception breakpoints, we print
11310 the exception name as "unhandled EXCEPTION_NAME", to make
11311 it clearer to the user which kind of catchpoint just got
11312 hit. We used ui_out_text to make sure that this extra
11313 info does not pollute the exception name in the MI case. */
11314 if (ex == ex_catch_exception_unhandled)
11315 ui_out_text (uiout, "unhandled ");
11316 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exception-name", exception_name);
11319 case ex_catch_assert:
11320 /* In this case, the name of the exception is not really
11321 important. Just print "failed assertion" to make it clearer
11322 that his program just hit an assertion-failure catchpoint.
11323 We used ui_out_text because this info does not belong in
11325 ui_out_text (uiout, "failed assertion");
11328 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
11329 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
11331 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
11334 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11335 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11338 print_one_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11339 struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11341 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11342 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11343 struct value_print_options opts;
11345 get_user_print_options (&opts);
11346 if (opts.addressprint)
11348 annotate_field (4);
11349 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr", b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
11352 annotate_field (5);
11353 *last_loc = b->loc;
11356 case ex_catch_exception:
11357 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11359 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string);
11361 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
11365 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "all Ada exceptions");
11369 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11370 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
11373 case ex_catch_assert:
11374 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "failed Ada assertions");
11378 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11383 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11384 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11387 print_mention_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11388 struct breakpoint *b)
11390 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11391 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11393 ui_out_text (uiout, b->disposition == disp_del ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
11394 : _("Catchpoint "));
11395 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
11396 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
11400 case ex_catch_exception:
11401 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11403 char *info = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), c->excep_string);
11404 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, info);
11406 ui_out_text (uiout, info);
11407 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11410 ui_out_text (uiout, _("all Ada exceptions"));
11413 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11414 ui_out_text (uiout, _("unhandled Ada exceptions"));
11417 case ex_catch_assert:
11418 ui_out_text (uiout, _("failed Ada assertions"));
11422 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11427 /* Implement the PRINT_RECREATE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
11428 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
11431 print_recreate_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
11432 struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11434 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
11438 case ex_catch_exception:
11439 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception");
11440 if (c->excep_string != NULL)
11441 fprintf_filtered (fp, " %s", c->excep_string);
11444 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11445 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception unhandled");
11448 case ex_catch_assert:
11449 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch assert");
11453 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
11455 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11458 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */
11461 dtor_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11463 dtor_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
11466 static struct bp_location *
11467 allocate_location_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *self)
11469 return allocate_location_exception (ex_catch_exception, self);
11473 re_set_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11475 re_set_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
11479 check_status_catch_exception (bpstat bs)
11481 check_status_exception (ex_catch_exception, bs);
11484 static enum print_stop_action
11485 print_it_catch_exception (bpstat bs)
11487 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception, bs);
11491 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11493 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception, b, last_loc);
11497 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
11499 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
11503 print_recreate_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11505 print_recreate_exception (ex_catch_exception, b, fp);
11508 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
11510 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */
11513 dtor_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11515 dtor_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11518 static struct bp_location *
11519 allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *self)
11521 return allocate_location_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, self);
11525 re_set_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11527 re_set_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11531 check_status_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs)
11533 check_status_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, bs);
11536 static enum print_stop_action
11537 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (bpstat bs)
11539 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, bs);
11543 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
11544 struct bp_location **last_loc)
11546 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_loc);
11550 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
11552 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
11556 print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b,
11557 struct ui_file *fp)
11559 print_recreate_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b, fp);
11562 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
11564 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */
11567 dtor_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11569 dtor_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
11572 static struct bp_location *
11573 allocate_location_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *self)
11575 return allocate_location_exception (ex_catch_assert, self);
11579 re_set_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11581 return re_set_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
11585 check_status_catch_assert (bpstat bs)
11587 check_status_exception (ex_catch_assert, bs);
11590 static enum print_stop_action
11591 print_it_catch_assert (bpstat bs)
11593 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_assert, bs);
11597 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
11599 print_one_exception (ex_catch_assert, b, last_loc);
11603 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
11605 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
11609 print_recreate_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11611 print_recreate_exception (ex_catch_assert, b, fp);
11614 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
11616 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token
11617 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that
11620 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */
11623 ada_get_next_arg (char **argsp)
11625 char *args = *argsp;
11629 args = skip_spaces (args);
11630 if (args[0] == '\0')
11631 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */
11633 /* Find the end of the current argument. */
11635 end = skip_to_space (args);
11637 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */
11641 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */
11643 result = xmalloc (end - args + 1);
11644 strncpy (result, args, end - args);
11645 result[end - args] = '\0';
11650 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
11651 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
11652 Set EXCEP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
11653 specified by the user.
11654 If a condition is found at the end of the arguments, the condition
11655 expression is stored in COND_STRING (memory must be deallocated
11656 after use). Otherwise COND_STRING is set to NULL. */
11659 catch_ada_exception_command_split (char *args,
11660 enum exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
11661 char **excep_string,
11662 char **cond_string)
11664 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11665 char *exception_name;
11668 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args);
11669 if (exception_name != NULL && strcmp (exception_name, "if") == 0)
11671 /* This is not an exception name; this is the start of a condition
11672 expression for a catchpoint on all exceptions. So, "un-get"
11673 this token, and set exception_name to NULL. */
11674 xfree (exception_name);
11675 exception_name = NULL;
11678 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name);
11680 /* Check to see if we have a condition. */
11682 args = skip_spaces (args);
11683 if (strncmp (args, "if", 2) == 0
11684 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
11687 args = skip_spaces (args);
11689 if (args[0] == '\0')
11690 error (_("Condition missing after `if' keyword"));
11691 cond = xstrdup (args);
11692 make_cleanup (xfree, cond);
11694 args += strlen (args);
11697 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
11700 if (args[0] != '\0')
11701 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
11703 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11705 if (exception_name == NULL)
11707 /* Catch all exceptions. */
11708 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
11709 *excep_string = NULL;
11711 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0)
11713 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
11714 *ex = ex_catch_exception_unhandled;
11715 *excep_string = NULL;
11719 /* Catch a specific exception. */
11720 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
11721 *excep_string = exception_name;
11723 *cond_string = cond;
11726 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
11727 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
11729 static const char *
11730 ada_exception_sym_name (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
11732 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11734 gdb_assert (data->exception_info != NULL);
11738 case ex_catch_exception:
11739 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
11741 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11742 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
11744 case ex_catch_assert:
11745 return (data->exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
11748 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11749 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
11753 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
11756 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
11757 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
11761 case ex_catch_exception:
11762 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
11764 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
11765 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
11767 case ex_catch_assert:
11768 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
11771 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11772 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
11776 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
11777 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
11778 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
11779 an exception catchpoint.
11781 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be
11782 deallocated later. */
11785 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string)
11789 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
11790 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
11791 EXCEP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
11792 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
11793 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
11794 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
11795 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
11796 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
11798 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
11799 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
11800 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
11801 standard.constraint_error".
11803 If an exception named contraint_error is defined in another package of
11804 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
11805 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
11806 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
11808 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
11810 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], excep_string) == 0)
11812 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&standard.%s)",
11816 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", excep_string);
11819 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
11820 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
11822 EXCEP_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception that
11823 the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise.
11825 ADDR_STRING returns the name of the function where the real
11826 breakpoint that implements the catchpoints is set, depending on the
11827 type of catchpoint we need to create. */
11829 static struct symtab_and_line
11830 ada_exception_sal (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *excep_string,
11831 char **addr_string, const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
11833 const char *sym_name;
11834 struct symbol *sym;
11836 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
11837 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
11839 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
11840 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
11841 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
11842 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11844 /* We can assume that SYM is not NULL at this stage. If the symbol
11845 did not exist, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer would have
11846 raised an exception.
11848 Also, ada_exception_support_info_sniffer should have already
11849 verified that SYM is a function symbol. */
11850 gdb_assert (sym != NULL);
11851 gdb_assert (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_BLOCK);
11853 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
11854 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name);
11857 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
11859 return find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
11862 /* Parse the arguments (ARGS) of the "catch exception" command.
11864 If the user asked the catchpoint to catch only a specific
11865 exception, then save the exception name in ADDR_STRING.
11867 If the user provided a condition, then set COND_STRING to
11868 that condition expression (the memory must be deallocated
11869 after use). Otherwise, set COND_STRING to NULL.
11871 See ada_exception_sal for a description of all the remaining
11872 function arguments of this function. */
11874 static struct symtab_and_line
11875 ada_decode_exception_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
11876 char **excep_string,
11877 char **cond_string,
11878 const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
11880 enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex;
11882 catch_ada_exception_command_split (args, &ex, excep_string, cond_string);
11883 return ada_exception_sal (ex, *excep_string, addr_string, ops);
11886 /* Create an Ada exception catchpoint. */
11889 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11890 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11892 char *excep_string,
11894 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11898 struct ada_catchpoint *c;
11900 c = XNEW (struct ada_catchpoint);
11901 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, sal, addr_string,
11902 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
11903 c->excep_string = excep_string;
11904 create_excep_cond_exprs (c);
11905 if (cond_string != NULL)
11906 set_breakpoint_condition (&c->base, cond_string, from_tty);
11907 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11910 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
11913 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
11914 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11916 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11918 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11919 char *addr_string = NULL;
11920 char *excep_string = NULL;
11921 char *cond_string = NULL;
11922 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
11924 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11928 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &excep_string,
11929 &cond_string, &ops);
11930 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string,
11931 excep_string, cond_string, ops,
11932 tempflag, from_tty);
11935 /* Assuming that ARGS contains the arguments of a "catch assert"
11936 command, parse those arguments and return a symtab_and_line object
11937 for a failed assertion catchpoint.
11939 Set ADDR_STRING to the name of the function where the real
11940 breakpoint that implements the catchpoint is set.
11942 If ARGS contains a condition, set COND_STRING to that condition
11943 (the memory needs to be deallocated after use). Otherwise, set
11944 COND_STRING to NULL. */
11946 static struct symtab_and_line
11947 ada_decode_assert_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
11948 char **cond_string,
11949 const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
11951 args = skip_spaces (args);
11953 /* Check whether a condition was provided. */
11954 if (strncmp (args, "if", 2) == 0
11955 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
11958 args = skip_spaces (args);
11959 if (args[0] == '\0')
11960 error (_("condition missing after `if' keyword"));
11961 *cond_string = xstrdup (args);
11964 /* Otherwise, there should be no other argument at the end of
11966 else if (args[0] != '\0')
11967 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11969 return ada_exception_sal (ex_catch_assert, NULL, addr_string, ops);
11972 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
11975 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
11976 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11978 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11980 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11981 char *addr_string = NULL;
11982 char *cond_string = NULL;
11983 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
11985 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11989 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &cond_string, &ops);
11990 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string,
11991 NULL, cond_string, ops, tempflag,
11995 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
11997 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
11999 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
12000 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
12001 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
12002 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
12003 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
12004 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
12005 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
12006 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
12007 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
12008 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
12009 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
12010 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
12011 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
12012 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
12013 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
12014 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
12015 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
12016 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
12017 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
12018 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
12021 ada_operator_length (const struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp,
12024 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
12027 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
12030 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
12031 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
12037 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
12042 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
12047 /* Implementation of the exp_descriptor method operator_check. */
12050 ada_operator_check (struct expression *exp, int pos,
12051 int (*objfile_func) (struct objfile *objfile, void *data),
12054 const union exp_element *const elts = exp->elts;
12055 struct type *type = NULL;
12057 switch (elts[pos].opcode)
12059 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
12061 type = elts[pos + 1].type;
12065 return operator_check_standard (exp, pos, objfile_func, data);
12068 /* Invoke callbacks for TYPE and OBJFILE if they were set as non-NULL. */
12070 if (type && TYPE_OBJFILE (type)
12071 && (*objfile_func) (TYPE_OBJFILE (type), data))
12078 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
12083 return op_name_standard (opcode);
12085 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
12090 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
12092 return "OP_CHOICES";
12098 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
12099 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
12100 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
12103 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
12104 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
12106 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
12109 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
12112 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
12113 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
12119 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
12124 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
12130 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
12132 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
12140 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
12142 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
12147 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
12151 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
12154 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
12158 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
12165 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
12167 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
12168 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
12169 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
12170 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
12171 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
12172 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
12174 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
12175 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
12176 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
12178 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
12183 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
12184 case OP_POSITIONAL:
12191 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
12192 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
12194 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
12199 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
12203 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
12204 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
12209 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
12212 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
12213 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
12215 int oplen, nargs, i;
12217 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
12219 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
12226 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
12230 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream);
12233 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
12234 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12235 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12236 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12237 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12238 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
12239 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
12240 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
12241 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
12244 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
12245 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
12246 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
12247 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12248 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12249 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12250 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
12251 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
12252 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
12253 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
12254 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12259 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
12263 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
12268 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
12270 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
12271 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0);
12275 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12276 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
12281 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
12283 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
12284 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
12286 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12291 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
12292 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
12293 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
12294 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12297 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
12298 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
12299 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12300 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
12301 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0);
12304 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
12305 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12306 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
12307 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12311 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
12312 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12316 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
12319 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
12320 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12322 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
12323 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12326 case OP_POSITIONAL:
12327 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12331 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
12332 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
12335 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
12336 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
12338 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
12343 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
12344 and precedences of the operators. */
12346 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
12347 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
12348 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
12349 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
12350 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
12351 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
12352 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
12353 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
12354 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
12355 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
12356 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
12357 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
12358 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
12359 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
12360 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
12361 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
12362 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
12363 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
12364 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
12365 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
12366 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
12367 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
12368 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
12369 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
12370 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12371 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12372 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12373 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12374 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
12375 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
12376 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
12377 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
12381 enum ada_primitive_types {
12382 ada_primitive_type_int,
12383 ada_primitive_type_long,
12384 ada_primitive_type_short,
12385 ada_primitive_type_char,
12386 ada_primitive_type_float,
12387 ada_primitive_type_double,
12388 ada_primitive_type_void,
12389 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
12390 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
12391 ada_primitive_type_natural,
12392 ada_primitive_type_positive,
12393 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
12394 nr_ada_primitive_types
12398 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12399 struct language_arch_info *lai)
12401 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
12403 lai->primitive_type_vector
12404 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
12407 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
12408 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
12410 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
12411 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
12412 0, "long_integer");
12413 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
12414 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
12415 0, "short_integer");
12416 lai->string_char_type
12417 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
12418 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
12419 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
12420 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
12422 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
12423 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
12424 "long_float", NULL);
12425 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
12426 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
12427 0, "long_long_integer");
12428 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
12429 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
12430 "long_long_float", NULL);
12431 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
12432 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
12434 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
12435 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
12437 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
12438 = builtin->builtin_void;
12440 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
12441 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, "void"));
12442 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
12443 = "system__address";
12445 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
12446 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
12449 /* Language vector */
12451 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
12454 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
12456 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
12462 warnings_issued = 0;
12463 return ada_parse ();
12466 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
12468 ada_operator_length,
12469 ada_operator_check,
12471 ada_dump_subexp_body,
12472 ada_evaluate_subexp
12475 /* Implement the "la_get_symbol_name_cmp" language_defn method
12478 static symbol_name_cmp_ftype
12479 ada_get_symbol_name_cmp (const char *lookup_name)
12481 if (should_use_wild_match (lookup_name))
12484 return compare_names;
12487 /* Implement the "la_read_var_value" language_defn method for Ada. */
12489 static struct value *
12490 ada_read_var_value (struct symbol *var, struct frame_info *frame)
12492 struct block *frame_block = NULL;
12493 struct symbol *renaming_sym = NULL;
12495 /* The only case where default_read_var_value is not sufficient
12496 is when VAR is a renaming... */
12498 frame_block = get_frame_block (frame, NULL);
12500 renaming_sym = ada_find_renaming_symbol (var, frame_block);
12501 if (renaming_sym != NULL)
12502 return ada_read_renaming_var_value (renaming_sym, frame_block);
12504 /* This is a typical case where we expect the default_read_var_value
12505 function to work. */
12506 return default_read_var_value (var, frame);
12509 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
12510 "ada", /* Language name */
12513 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
12514 that's not quite what this means. */
12516 macro_expansion_no,
12517 &ada_exp_descriptor,
12521 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
12522 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
12523 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
12524 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
12525 ada_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
12526 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */
12527 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
12528 ada_read_var_value, /* la_read_var_value */
12529 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
12530 NULL, /* name_of_this */
12531 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
12532 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
12533 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
12534 NULL, /* Language specific
12535 class_name_from_physname */
12536 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
12537 0, /* c-style arrays */
12538 1, /* String lower bound */
12539 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
12540 ada_make_symbol_completion_list,
12541 ada_language_arch_info,
12542 ada_print_array_index,
12543 default_pass_by_reference,
12545 ada_get_symbol_name_cmp, /* la_get_symbol_name_cmp */
12546 ada_iterate_over_symbols,
12550 /* Provide a prototype to silence -Wmissing-prototypes. */
12551 extern initialize_file_ftype _initialize_ada_language;
12553 /* Command-list for the "set/show ada" prefix command. */
12554 static struct cmd_list_element *set_ada_list;
12555 static struct cmd_list_element *show_ada_list;
12557 /* Implement the "set ada" prefix command. */
12560 set_ada_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12562 printf_unfiltered (_(\
12563 "\"set ada\" must be followed by the name of a setting.\n"));
12564 help_list (set_ada_list, "set ada ", -1, gdb_stdout);
12567 /* Implement the "show ada" prefix command. */
12570 show_ada_command (char *args, int from_tty)
12572 cmd_show_list (show_ada_list, from_tty, "");
12576 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (void)
12578 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
12580 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
12582 ops = &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
12583 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
12584 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception;
12585 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception;
12586 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception;
12587 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception;
12588 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception;
12589 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception;
12590 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception;
12591 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception;
12593 ops = &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
12594 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
12595 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exception_unhandled;
12596 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_exception_unhandled;
12597 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_exception_unhandled;
12598 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_exception_unhandled;
12599 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exception_unhandled;
12600 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exception_unhandled;
12601 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled;
12602 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exception_unhandled;
12604 ops = &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
12605 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
12606 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_assert;
12607 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_catch_assert;
12608 ops->re_set = re_set_catch_assert;
12609 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_assert;
12610 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_assert;
12611 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_assert;
12612 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_assert;
12613 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_assert;
12617 _initialize_ada_language (void)
12619 add_language (&ada_language_defn);
12621 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops ();
12623 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, set_ada_command,
12624 _("Prefix command for changing Ada-specfic settings"),
12625 &set_ada_list, "set ada ", 0, &setlist);
12627 add_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class, show_ada_command,
12628 _("Generic command for showing Ada-specific settings."),
12629 &show_ada_list, "show ada ", 0, &showlist);
12631 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("trust-PAD-over-XVS", class_obscure,
12632 &trust_pad_over_xvs, _("\
12633 Enable or disable an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types"), _("\
12634 Show whether an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types is activated"),
12636 This is related to the encoding used by the GNAT compiler. The debugger\n\
12637 should normally trust the contents of PAD types, but certain older versions\n\
12638 of GNAT have a bug that sometimes causes the information in the PAD type\n\
12639 to be incorrect. Turning this setting \"off\" allows the debugger to\n\
12640 work around this bug. It is always safe to turn this option \"off\", but\n\
12641 this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is recommended to NOT change\n\
12642 this option to \"off\" unless necessary."),
12643 NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
12645 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
12646 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
12647 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12648 catch_ada_exception_command,
12652 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
12653 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
12654 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12655 catch_assert_command,
12660 varsize_limit = 65536;
12662 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
12664 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc
12665 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq,
12666 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
12668 /* Setup per-inferior data. */
12669 observer_attach_inferior_exit (ada_inferior_exit);
12671 = register_inferior_data_with_cleanup (NULL, ada_inferior_data_cleanup);